]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blame - ld/ld.texi
ld: Add -no-pie
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
CommitLineData
252b5132
RH
1\input texinfo
2@setfilename ld.info
250d07de 3@c Copyright (C) 1991-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 4@syncodeindex ky cp
dff70155 5@c man begin INCLUDE
252b5132
RH
6@include configdoc.texi
7@c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
c428fa83 8@include bfdver.texi
dff70155 9@c man end
252b5132
RH
10
11@c @smallbook
12
ff5dcc92
SC
13@macro gcctabopt{body}
14@code{\body\}
15@end macro
16
0285c67d
NC
17@c man begin NAME
18@ifset man
19@c Configure for the generation of man pages
20@set UsesEnvVars
21@set GENERIC
0285c67d 22@set ARM
ac145307 23@set C6X
b8891f8d 24@set CSKY
49fa1e15 25@set H8300
0285c67d 26@set HPPA
0285c67d 27@set M68HC11
7fb9f789 28@set M68K
833794fc 29@set MIPS
3c3bdf30 30@set MMIX
2469cfa2 31@set MSP430
35c08157 32@set NDS32
78058a5e 33@set NIOSII
fa1477dc 34@set PDP11
2a60a7a8
AM
35@set POWERPC
36@set POWERPC64
49fa1e15 37@set Renesas
b4cbbe8f 38@set S/390
49fa1e15
AM
39@set SPU
40@set TICOFF
2ca22b03 41@set WIN32
e0001a05 42@set XTENSA
0285c67d
NC
43@end ifset
44@c man end
45
9160ea82
AM
46@ifnottex
47@dircategory Software development
48@direntry
252b5132 49* Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
9160ea82
AM
50@end direntry
51@end ifnottex
252b5132 52
0e9517a9 53@copying
e49e529d
JM
54This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57@end ifset
58version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 59
250d07de 60Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 61
cf055d54 62Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 63under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
cf055d54
NC
64or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 67section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0e9517a9 68@end copying
252b5132
RH
69@iftex
70@finalout
71@setchapternewpage odd
71ba23f6 72@settitle The GNU linker
252b5132 73@titlepage
71ba23f6 74@title The GNU linker
252b5132 75@sp 1
e49e529d
JM
76@subtitle @code{ld}
77@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79@end ifset
252b5132
RH
80@subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81@author Steve Chamberlain
82@author Ian Lance Taylor
252b5132
RH
83@page
84
85@tex
86{\parskip=0pt
704c465c
NC
87\hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88\hfill nickc\@credhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
71ba23f6 89\hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
252b5132
RH
90\hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91}
92\global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93@end tex
94
95@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
0285c67d 96@c man begin COPYRIGHT
250d07de 97Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 98
0285c67d 99Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 100under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
0285c67d
NC
101or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 104section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0285c67d 105@c man end
252b5132 106
252b5132
RH
107@end titlepage
108@end iftex
4ecceb71 109@contents
252b5132
RH
110@c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
84ec0e6d 112@ifnottex
252b5132 113@node Top
71ba23f6 114@top LD
e49e529d
JM
115This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118@end ifset
119version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 120
cf055d54 121This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
793c5807
NC
122Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
cf055d54 124
252b5132
RH
125@menu
126* Overview:: Overview
127* Invocation:: Invocation
128* Scripts:: Linker Scripts
bf6d8037 129* Plugins:: Linker Plugins
252b5132
RH
130@ifset GENERIC
131* Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
132@end ifset
133@ifclear GENERIC
134@ifset H8300
135* H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
136@end ifset
c2dcd04e
NC
137@ifset Renesas
138* Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
252b5132 139@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
140@ifset ARM
141* ARM:: ld and the ARM family
142@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
143@ifset M68HC11
144* M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
145@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
146@ifset HPPA
147* HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
148@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
149@ifset M68K
150* M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
151@end ifset
833794fc
MR
152@ifset MIPS
153* MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
154@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
155@ifset POWERPC
156* PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
157@end ifset
158@ifset POWERPC64
159* PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
160@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
161@ifset S/390
162* S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
163@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
164@ifset SPU
165* SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
166@end ifset
74459f0e
TW
167@ifset TICOFF
168* TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
169@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
170@ifset WIN32
171* Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
172@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
173@ifset XTENSA
174* Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
175@end ifset
252b5132
RH
176@end ifclear
177@ifclear SingleFormat
178* BFD:: BFD
179@end ifclear
180@c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
181
182* Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
183* MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
704c465c 184* GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
370b66a1 185* LD Index:: LD Index
252b5132 186@end menu
84ec0e6d 187@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
188
189@node Overview
190@chapter Overview
191
192@cindex @sc{gnu} linker
193@cindex what is this?
0285c67d 194
0879a67a 195@ifset man
0285c67d 196@c man begin SYNOPSIS
ff5dcc92 197ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
0285c67d
NC
198@c man end
199
200@c man begin SEEALSO
201ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
202the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
203@file{ld}.
204@c man end
205@end ifset
206
207@c man begin DESCRIPTION
208
ff5dcc92 209@command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
252b5132 210their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
ff5dcc92 211compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
252b5132 212
ff5dcc92 213@command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
252b5132
RH
214a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
215to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
216
0285c67d
NC
217@ifset man
218@c For the man only
ece2d90e 219This man page does not describe the command language; see the
71ba23f6
NC
220@command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
221language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
0285c67d
NC
222@end ifset
223
252b5132 224@ifclear SingleFormat
ff5dcc92
SC
225This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
226to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
252b5132
RH
227write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
228@code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
229available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
230@end ifclear
231
232Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
233linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
234execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
ff5dcc92 235@command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
252b5132
RH
236(or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
237
0285c67d
NC
238@c man end
239
252b5132
RH
240@node Invocation
241@chapter Invocation
242
0285c67d
NC
243@c man begin DESCRIPTION
244
ff5dcc92 245The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
252b5132
RH
246and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
247you have many choices to control its behavior.
248
0285c67d
NC
249@c man end
250
252b5132
RH
251@ifset UsesEnvVars
252@menu
a05a5b64 253* Options:: Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
254* Environment:: Environment Variables
255@end menu
256
257@node Options
a05a5b64 258@section Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
259@end ifset
260
261@cindex command line
262@cindex options
0285c67d
NC
263
264@c man begin OPTIONS
265
252b5132
RH
266The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
267practice few of them are used in any particular context.
268@cindex standard Unix system
ff5dcc92 269For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
252b5132
RH
270object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
271link a file @code{hello.o}:
272
273@smallexample
274ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
275@end smallexample
276
ff5dcc92 277This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
252b5132
RH
278result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
279the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
280directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
281
ff5dcc92 282Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
511ab9e9
ILT
283point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
284as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
285which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
286files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
287different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
252b5132
RH
288occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
289option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
290noted in the descriptions below.
291
292@cindex object files
511ab9e9
ILT
293Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
294together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
295options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
296an option and its argument.
252b5132
RH
297
298Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
299specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
300and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
301are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
302message @samp{No input files}.
303
36f63dca 304If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
252b5132
RH
305assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
306augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
307linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
308permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
309or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
53d25da6
AM
310@code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
311script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
312extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
313to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
314the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
252b5132
RH
315
316For options whose names are a single letter,
317option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
318whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
319option that requires them.
320
321For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
e4897a32 322precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
36f63dca 323@samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
e4897a32 324this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
ba1be17e 325only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
e4897a32
NC
326@samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
327name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
328output.
329
330Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
331option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
332immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
333@samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
334Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
335accepted.
252b5132 336
36f63dca 337Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
a05a5b64 338(e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
fa19fce0
NC
339prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
340compiler driver) like this:
4e53152f
NC
341
342@smallexample
2509a395 343 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
4e53152f
NC
344@end smallexample
345
346This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
2509a395
SL
347silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
348may also arise when passing options that require values through a
349driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
350a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
351and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
352the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
353
354@smallexample
355 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
356@end smallexample
4e53152f 357
a05a5b64 358Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
4e53152f
NC
359linker:
360
ff5dcc92 361@table @gcctabopt
38fc1cb1 362@include at-file.texi
dff70155 363
2509a395
SL
364@kindex -a @var{keyword}
365@item -a @var{keyword}
252b5132
RH
366This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
367argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
368@samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
369@samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
370to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
371
7ee314fa
AM
372@kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373@item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
374Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
375@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
376specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
377will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
378finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
9d5777a3 379it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
7ee314fa 380This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
9d5777a3 381interface.
7ee314fa 382
252b5132
RH
383@ifclear SingleFormat
384@cindex binary input format
385@kindex -b @var{format}
386@kindex --format=@var{format}
387@cindex input format
388@cindex input format
389@item -b @var{input-format}
390@itemx --format=@var{input-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
391@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
392file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 393@samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
ff5dcc92 394that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
252b5132 395configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
ff5dcc92 396to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
252b5132
RH
397default input format the most usual format on each machine.
398@var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
399supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
400formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
401@xref{BFD}.
402
403You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
404binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
405linking object files of different formats), by including
406@samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
a1ab1d2a 407particular format.
252b5132
RH
408
409The default format is taken from the environment variable
410@code{GNUTARGET}.
411@ifset UsesEnvVars
412@xref{Environment}.
413@end ifset
414You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
0285c67d
NC
415@code{TARGET};
416@ifclear man
417see @ref{Format Commands}.
418@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
419@end ifclear
420
421@kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
422@kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
423@cindex compatibility, MRI
424@item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
425@itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
ff5dcc92 426For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
252b5132 427files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
0285c67d
NC
428@ifclear man
429@ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
430@end ifclear
431@ifset man
432the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
433@end ifset
434Introduce MRI script files with
252b5132 435the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
ff5dcc92
SC
436scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
437If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
252b5132
RH
438specified by any @samp{-L} options.
439
440@cindex common allocation
441@kindex -d
442@kindex -dc
443@kindex -dp
a1ab1d2a 444@item -d
252b5132
RH
445@itemx -dc
446@itemx -dp
447These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
448compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
449even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
450script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
451@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
452
7ee314fa
AM
453@kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
454@kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
455@item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
456@itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
457Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
458@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
459specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
460will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
461option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
9d5777a3 462The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
7ee314fa 463
abf874aa
CL
464@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
466This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
467fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
468section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
469error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
470several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
471section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
472sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
473
474@smallexample
475 MEMORY @{
476 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
477 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
478 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
479 @}
480 SECTIONS @{
481 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
482 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
484 @}
485
486 with input sections:
487 .data.1: size 8
488 .data.2: size 0x10
489 .data.3: size 4
490
491 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
492 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
493@end smallexample
494
495This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
496the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
497
498@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
500This option enables warnings when
501@code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
502matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
503discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
504output region.
505
252b5132
RH
506@cindex entry point, from command line
507@kindex -e @var{entry}
508@kindex --entry=@var{entry}
a1ab1d2a 509@item -e @var{entry}
252b5132
RH
510@itemx --entry=@var{entry}
511Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
512program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
513named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
514and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
515base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
516@samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
517and other ways of specifying the entry point.
518
b58f81ae
DJ
519@kindex --exclude-libs
520@item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
521Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
e1c37eb5 522exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
b58f81ae
DJ
523@code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
524automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
525port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
526explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
527option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
528be treated as hidden.
529
e1c37eb5
DK
530@kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
531@item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
532Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
533should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
534into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
535may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
536used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
537the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
538match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
539command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
540of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
541regardless of this option.
542
252b5132
RH
543@cindex dynamic symbol table
544@kindex -E
545@kindex --export-dynamic
267e2722 546@kindex --no-export-dynamic
252b5132
RH
547@item -E
548@itemx --export-dynamic
267e2722
CD
549@itemx --no-export-dynamic
550When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
551option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
552all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
553set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
554
555If you do not use either of these options (or use the
556@option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
557dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
558referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
252b5132
RH
559
560If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
561back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
562dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
563linking the program itself.
564
55255dae 565You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
cb840a31 566be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
55255dae 567See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
cb840a31 568
8b747e1a
DK
569Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
570support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
571the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
572
37a141bf
FS
573@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
574@cindex export dynamic symbol
575@item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
576When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
577@var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
578shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
579bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
580no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
581@samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
582on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
583
584@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
585@cindex export dynamic symbol list
586@item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
587Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
588The format of the file is the same as the version node without
589scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
590
36f63dca 591@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
592@cindex big-endian objects
593@cindex endianness
594@kindex -EB
595@item -EB
596Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
597
598@cindex little-endian objects
599@kindex -EL
600@item -EL
601Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
36f63dca 602@end ifclear
252b5132 603
2509a395
SL
604@kindex -f @var{name}
605@kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
606@item -f @var{name}
607@itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
608When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
609to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
610table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
611symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
612
613If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
614run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
615the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
616first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
617@var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
618in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
619Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
620implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
a094d01f 621machine-specific performance.
252b5132
RH
622
623This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
624will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
625
2509a395
SL
626@kindex -F @var{name}
627@kindex --filter=@var{name}
252b5132 628@item -F @var{name}
2509a395 629@itemx --filter=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
630When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
631the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
632of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
633on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
634
635If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
636run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
637dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
638filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
639found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
640used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
641@var{name}.
642
ff5dcc92 643Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
252b5132 644toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
36f63dca
NC
645object files.
646@ifclear SingleFormat
647The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
ece2d90e 648@option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
252b5132 649@code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
36f63dca
NC
650environment variable.
651@end ifclear
652The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
653creating an ELF shared object.
252b5132 654
3dbf70a2 655@cindex finalization function
2509a395
SL
656@kindex -fini=@var{name}
657@item -fini=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
658When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
659executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
660address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
661the function to call.
662
252b5132
RH
663@kindex -g
664@item -g
665Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
666
2509a395
SL
667@kindex -G @var{value}
668@kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
252b5132 669@cindex object size
2509a395 670@item -G @var{value}
252b5132
RH
671@itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
672Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
673@var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
e8044f35 674MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
252b5132
RH
675sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
676
677@cindex runtime library name
2509a395 678@kindex -h @var{name}
252b5132 679@kindex -soname=@var{name}
2509a395 680@item -h @var{name}
252b5132
RH
681@itemx -soname=@var{name}
682When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
683the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
684which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
685linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
686field rather than the using the file name given to the linker.
687
688@kindex -i
689@cindex incremental link
690@item -i
691Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
692
3dbf70a2 693@cindex initialization function
2509a395
SL
694@kindex -init=@var{name}
695@item -init=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
696When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
697executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
698of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
699function to call.
700
252b5132 701@cindex archive files, from cmd line
2509a395 702@kindex -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf 703@kindex --library=@var{namespec}
2509a395 704@item -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf
RS
705@itemx --library=@var{namespec}
706Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
707list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
708If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
07d8eb55 709will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
bcb674cf 710will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
252b5132 711
ff5dcc92 712On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
bcb674cf
RS
713files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
714and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
715called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
716@file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
717indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
718to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
719@var{filename}.
252b5132
RH
720
721The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
722specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
723was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
724command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
725archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
726the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
727
ff5dcc92 728See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
252b5132
RH
729archives multiple times.
730
731You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
732
733@ifset GENERIC
734This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
ff5dcc92 735if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
252b5132
RH
736behaviour of the AIX linker.
737@end ifset
738
739@cindex search directory, from cmd line
2509a395 740@kindex -L @var{dir}
252b5132 741@kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
2509a395 742@item -L @var{searchdir}
252b5132 743@itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
ff5dcc92
SC
744Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
745for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
252b5132
RH
746option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
747in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
748on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
ff5dcc92 749@option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
7d24f02c
KH
750order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
751how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
752option is specified.
252b5132 753
3aa2d05a
NC
754If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
755prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
756@samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
9c8ebd6a 757
252b5132
RH
758@ifset UsesEnvVars
759The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
ff5dcc92 760@samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
252b5132
RH
761some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
762@end ifset
763
764The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
765@code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
766at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
767
768@cindex emulation
769@kindex -m @var{emulation}
2509a395 770@item -m @var{emulation}
252b5132
RH
771Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
772emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
773
774If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
775@code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
776
777Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
778configured.
779
780@cindex link map
781@kindex -M
782@kindex --print-map
783@item -M
784@itemx --print-map
785Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
786information about the link, including the following:
787
788@itemize @bullet
789@item
3b83e13a 790Where object files are mapped into memory.
252b5132
RH
791@item
792How common symbols are allocated.
793@item
794All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
795which caused the archive member to be brought in.
3b83e13a
NC
796@item
797The values assigned to symbols.
798
799Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
800involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
801have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
802linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
803of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
804the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
805linker script containing:
806
807@smallexample
808 foo = 1
809 foo = foo * 4
810 foo = foo + 8
811@end smallexample
812
813will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
814option is used:
815
816@smallexample
817 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
818 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
819 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
820@end smallexample
821
822See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
823scripts.
d2ef37eb 824
06ddcada
AM
825@item
826How GNU properties are merged.
d2ef37eb 827
06ddcada
AM
828When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
829.note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
830These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
d2ef37eb
L
831
832@smallexample
833Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
834@end smallexample
835
06ddcada 836This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
d2ef37eb
L
837merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
838is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
839
840@smallexample
06ddcada 841Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
d2ef37eb
L
842@end smallexample
843
06ddcada 844This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
d2ef37eb
L
845when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
846is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
252b5132
RH
847@end itemize
848
035801ce
FS
849@cindex link map discarded
850@kindex --print-map-discarded
851@kindex --no-print-map-discarded
852@item --print-map-discarded
853@itemx --no-print-map-discarded
854Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
855in the link map. Enabled by default.
856
252b5132
RH
857@kindex -n
858@cindex read-only text
859@cindex NMAGIC
860@kindex --nmagic
861@item -n
862@itemx --nmagic
90f5d9d9
JZ
863Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
864libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
865mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
252b5132
RH
866
867@kindex -N
868@kindex --omagic
869@cindex read/write from cmd line
870@cindex OMAGIC
a1ab1d2a 871@item -N
252b5132
RH
872@itemx --omagic
873Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
63fd3b82
NC
874not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
875libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
4d8907ac
DS
876mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
877is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
878specification published by Microsoft.
63fd3b82
NC
879
880@kindex --no-omagic
881@cindex OMAGIC
882@item --no-omagic
883This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
884sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
885be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
886shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
252b5132
RH
887
888@kindex -o @var{output}
889@kindex --output=@var{output}
890@cindex naming the output file
891@item -o @var{output}
892@itemx --output=@var{output}
ff5dcc92 893Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
252b5132
RH
894option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
895script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
896
f37b21b4
RM
897@kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
898@cindex dependency file
899@item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
900Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
901suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
902that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
903output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
904Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
905Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
906to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
907linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
908@samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
909installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
910distributed makefiles without careful editing.
911
252b5132
RH
912@kindex -O @var{level}
913@cindex generating optimized output
914@item -O @var{level}
ff5dcc92 915If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
252b5132 916the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
98c503ac
NC
917should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
918option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
919the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
920no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
921of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
252b5132 922
387dd777
DP
923@kindex -plugin @var{name}
924@item -plugin @var{name}
925Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
926the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
927automatically added by the complier, when using link time
928optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
929wish.
930
931Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
932from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
933@command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
934those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
41f37a6f 935copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
387dd777 936based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
6c19b93b 937just copy in the newest one.
387dd777 938
26278bb8
UD
939@kindex --push-state
940@cindex push state governing input file handling
941@item --push-state
f9a6a8f0 942The @option{--push-state} allows one to preserve the current state of the
26278bb8
UD
943flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
944restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
945
946The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
947@option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
948@option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
949@option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
950@option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
951@option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
952
953One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
954used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
955listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
956something as follows:
957
958@smallexample
959-Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
960@end smallexample
961
962@kindex --pop-state
963@cindex pop state governing input file handling
67cecaba 964@item --pop-state
26278bb8
UD
965Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
966flags governing input file handling.
967
a712da20
NC
968@kindex -q
969@kindex --emit-relocs
970@cindex retain relocations in final executable
971@item -q
972@itemx --emit-relocs
ba1be17e 973Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
a712da20
NC
974Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
975order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
976in larger executables.
977
dbab7a7b
NC
978This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
979
4f471f39
RS
980@kindex --force-dynamic
981@cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
982@item --force-dynamic
983Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
984to VxWorks targets.
985
252b5132
RH
986@cindex partial link
987@cindex relocatable output
988@kindex -r
1049f94e 989@kindex --relocatable
252b5132 990@item -r
1049f94e 991@itemx --relocatable
252b5132 992Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 993turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
252b5132
RH
994linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
995magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
996@code{OMAGIC}.
ff5dcc92 997@c ; see @option{-N}.
252b5132
RH
998If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
999linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
1000constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1001
62bf86b4
HPN
1002When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1003partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1004relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1005example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1006with input files in other formats at all.
1007
252b5132
RH
1008This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1009
1010@kindex -R @var{file}
1011@kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1012@cindex symbol-only input
1013@item -R @var{filename}
1014@itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1015Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1016relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1017to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1018programs. You may use this option more than once.
1019
ff5dcc92 1020For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 1021followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 1022the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
1023
1024@kindex -s
1025@kindex --strip-all
1026@cindex strip all symbols
a1ab1d2a 1027@item -s
252b5132
RH
1028@itemx --strip-all
1029Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1030
1031@kindex -S
1032@kindex --strip-debug
1033@cindex strip debugger symbols
a1ab1d2a 1034@item -S
252b5132
RH
1035@itemx --strip-debug
1036Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1037
a70f34c0
NC
1038@kindex --strip-discarded
1039@kindex --no-strip-discarded
1040@item --strip-discarded
1041@itemx --no-strip-discarded
1042Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1043Enabled by default.
1044
252b5132
RH
1045@kindex -t
1046@kindex --trace
1047@cindex input files, displaying
a1ab1d2a 1048@item -t
252b5132 1049@itemx --trace
4f4690cd
AM
1050Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1051@samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1052@samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1053and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1054a linker bug report.
252b5132
RH
1055
1056@kindex -T @var{script}
1057@kindex --script=@var{script}
1058@cindex script files
1059@item -T @var{scriptfile}
1060@itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1061Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
ff5dcc92 1062@command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
252b5132 1063@var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
114283d8
NC
1064output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1065the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1066specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1067options accumulate.
252b5132 1068
14be8564
L
1069@kindex -dT @var{script}
1070@kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1071@cindex script files
1072@item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1073@itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1074Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1075
1076This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1077processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1078command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1079@option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1080behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1081command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1082the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1083@samp{gcc}).
1084
252b5132
RH
1085@kindex -u @var{symbol}
1086@kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1087@cindex undefined symbol
1088@item -u @var{symbol}
1089@itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1090Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1091symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1092modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1093different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1094option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1095
0a618243
AB
1096If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1097into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1098undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1099instead.
1100
1101@kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1102@cindex symbols, require defined
1103@cindex defined symbol
1104@item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1105Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1106is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1107is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1108and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1109@code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1110can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1111
252b5132
RH
1112@kindex -Ur
1113@cindex constructors
a1ab1d2a 1114@item -Ur
252b5132
RH
1115For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1116@samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 1117turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
252b5132
RH
1118@emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1119It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1120with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1121be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1122@samp{-r} for the others.
1123
c005eb9e
AB
1124@kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1125@cindex orphan sections
1126@cindex sections, orphan
1127@item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1128Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1129specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1130
1131@var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1132
1133@table @code
1134@item place
1135Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1136the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
d2732b69 1137@samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
c005eb9e
AB
1138
1139@item discard
1140All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1141@samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1142
1143@item warn
1144The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1145issue a warning.
1146
1147@item error
1148The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1149@end table
1150
1151The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1152
577a0623
AM
1153@kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154@item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1155Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1156@var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1157missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1158specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1159multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1160input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1161in a linker script.
a854a4a7 1162
252b5132
RH
1163@kindex -v
1164@kindex -V
1165@kindex --version
1166@cindex version
1167@item -v
1168@itemx --version
1169@itemx -V
ff5dcc92 1170Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
252b5132
RH
1171lists the supported emulations.
1172
1173@kindex -x
1174@kindex --discard-all
1175@cindex deleting local symbols
1176@item -x
1177@itemx --discard-all
1178Delete all local symbols.
1179
1180@kindex -X
1181@kindex --discard-locals
1182@cindex local symbols, deleting
a1ab1d2a 1183@item -X
252b5132 1184@itemx --discard-locals
3c68c38f
BW
1185Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1186system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1187or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
252b5132
RH
1188
1189@kindex -y @var{symbol}
1190@kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1191@cindex symbol tracing
1192@item -y @var{symbol}
1193@itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1194Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1195option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1196to prepend an underscore.
1197
1198This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1199don't know where the reference is coming from.
1200
1201@kindex -Y @var{path}
1202@item -Y @var{path}
1203Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1204for Solaris compatibility.
1205
1206@kindex -z @var{keyword}
1207@item -z @var{keyword}
cd6d6c15
NC
1208The recognized keywords are:
1209@table @samp
1210
e6e2dfbd
AM
1211@item bndplt
1212Always generate BND prefix in PLT entries. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1213
1214@item call-nop=prefix-addr
1215@itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1216@itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1217@itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1218Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1219to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1220@option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1221@option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1222@option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1223@option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1224Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1225
233a0083
L
1226@item cet-report=none
1227@itemx cet-report=warning
1228@itemx cet-report=error
1229Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1230GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1231section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1232linker not report missing properties in input files.
1233@option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1234missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1235the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1236Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1237GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1238turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1239Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1240
cd6d6c15 1241@item combreloc
e6e2dfbd
AM
1242@itemx nocombreloc
1243Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1244dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
cd6d6c15 1245
b8871f35 1246@item common
e6e2dfbd
AM
1247@itemx nocommon
1248Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1249link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1250
1251@item common-page-size=@var{value}
1252Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1253layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1254using pages of this size.
b8871f35 1255
cd6d6c15 1256@item defs
97a232d7
NC
1257Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1258is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1259This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
cd6d6c15 1260
e6e2dfbd
AM
1261@item dynamic-undefined-weak
1262@itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1263Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1264if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1265by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1266@samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1267may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1268selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1269these options.
1270
6aa29e7b
JJ
1271@item execstack
1272Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1273
b039ef04
L
1274@item global
1275This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1276the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1277of subsequently loaded libraries.
1278
93ab9c0d
NC
1279@item globalaudit
1280This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1281This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1282setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1283tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
a05a5b64 1284the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
6c19b93b 1285all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
93ab9c0d 1286
e6e2dfbd
AM
1287@item ibtplt
1288Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1289Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1290
8df93cb5 1291@item ibt
e6e2dfbd
AM
1292Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1293to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1294Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1295
cd6d6c15
NC
1296@item initfirst
1297This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1298It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1299before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1300the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1301the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1302objects.
1303
1304@item interpose
e6e2dfbd
AM
1305Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1306so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1307libraries not so marked.
cd6d6c15 1308
c3805e4c
VDM
1309@item unique
1310@itemx nounique
1311When generating a shared library or other dynamically loadable ELF
1312object mark it as one that should (by default) only ever be loaded once,
1313and only in the main namespace (when using @code{dlmopen}). This is
1314primarily used to mark fundamental libraries such as libc, libpthread et
1315al which do not usually function correctly unless they are the sole instances
1316of themselves. This behaviour can be overridden by the @code{dlmopen} caller
1317and does not apply to certain loading mechanisms (such as audit libraries).
1318
279d901e
L
1319@item lam-u48
1320Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 in .note.gnu.property section
1321to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U48. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1322
1323@item lam-u57
1324Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 in .note.gnu.property section
1325to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U57. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1326
1327@item lam-u48-report=none
1328@itemx lam-u48-report=warning
1329@itemx lam-u48-report=error
1330Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48
1331property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1332@option{lam-u48-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1333linker not report missing properties in input files.
1334@option{lam-u48-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1335missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u48-report=error} will
1336make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1337Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1338
1339@item lam-u57-report=none
1340@itemx lam-u57-report=warning
1341@itemx lam-u57-report=error
1342Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57
1343property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1344@option{lam-u57-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1345linker not report missing properties in input files.
1346@option{lam-u57-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1347missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u57-report=error} will
1348make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1349Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1350
1351@item lam-report=none
1352@itemx lam-report=warning
1353@itemx lam-report=error
1354Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 and
1355GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 properties in input .note.gnu.property
1356section. @option{lam-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1357linker not report missing properties in input files.
1358@option{lam-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1359missing properties in input files. @option{lam-report=error} will make
1360the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1361Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1362
5fa222e4
AM
1363@item lazy
1364When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1365dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1366the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1367Lazy binding is the default.
1368
cd6d6c15 1369@item loadfltr
e6e2dfbd 1370Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
cd6d6c15 1371
e6e2dfbd
AM
1372@item max-page-size=@var{value}
1373Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
cd6d6c15 1374
e6e2dfbd
AM
1375@item muldefs
1376Allow multiple definitions.
b8871f35 1377
cd6d6c15 1378@item nocopyreloc
daf220f0
AM
1379Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1380defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
cd6d6c15
NC
1381
1382@item nodefaultlib
e6e2dfbd
AM
1383Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1384should ignore any default library search paths.
cd6d6c15
NC
1385
1386@item nodelete
e6e2dfbd 1387Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
cd6d6c15
NC
1388
1389@item nodlopen
e6e2dfbd 1390Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
cd6d6c15
NC
1391
1392@item nodump
e6e2dfbd 1393Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
cd6d6c15 1394
6aa29e7b
JJ
1395@item noexecstack
1396Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1397
e6e2dfbd
AM
1398@item noextern-protected-data
1399Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1400library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1401used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1402generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1403module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1404i386 and x86-64.
8dfef1bd 1405
e6e2dfbd
AM
1406@item noreloc-overflow
1407Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1408relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1409overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
6aa29e7b 1410
cd6d6c15
NC
1411@item now
1412When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1413dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
e6e2dfbd
AM
1414when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1415function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1416called.
cd6d6c15
NC
1417
1418@item origin
e6e2dfbd 1419Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
cd6d6c15 1420
6aa29e7b 1421@item relro
e6e2dfbd 1422@itemx norelro
def5c83c
AM
1423Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1424specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1425relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1426than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
e6e2dfbd 1427Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
6aa29e7b 1428
68b00778
L
1429@item report-relative-reloc
1430Report dynamic relative relocations generated by linker. Supported for
1431Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1432
47acac12
L
1433@item separate-code
1434@itemx noseparate-code
1435Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1436specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1437be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1438code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1439
496afd17
L
1440@item unique-symbol
1441@itemx nounique-symbol
1442Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1443".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1444is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1445
e6e2dfbd
AM
1446@item shstk
1447Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1448to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1449Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
24718e3b 1450
04c3a755 1451@item stack-size=@var{value}
e6e2dfbd 1452Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
04c3a755
NS
1453Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1454@code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1455
8ee10e86
AM
1456@item start-stop-gc
1457@itemx nostart-stop-gc
1458@cindex start-stop-gc
1459When @samp{--gc-sections} is in effect, a reference from a retained
1460section to @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} causes all
1461input sections named @code{SECNAME} to also be retained, if
1462@code{SECNAME} is representable as a C identifier and either
1463@code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} is synthesized by the
1464linker. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} disables this effect, allowing
1465sections to be garbage collected as if the special synthesized symbols
1466were not defined. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} has no effect on a
1467definition of @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} in an
1468object file or linker script. Such a definition will prevent the
1469linker providing a synthesized @code{__start_SECNAME} or
1470@code{__stop_SECNAME} respectively, and therefore the special
1471treatment by garbage collection for those references.
1472
cae64165
RM
1473@item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1474@cindex visibility
1475@cindex ELF symbol visibility
1476Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1477@code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1478Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1479@samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1480start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1481compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1482recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1483programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1484between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1485
e6e2dfbd
AM
1486@item text
1487@itemx notext
1488@itemx textoff
a6dbf402
L
1489Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1490or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1491report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
48580982 1492
97a232d7
NC
1493@item undefs
1494Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1495either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1496This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1497
b0ab0693 1498@item x86-64-baseline
32930e4e
L
1499@item x86-64-v2
1500@item x86-64-v3
1501@itemx x86-64-v4
1502Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
b0ab0693 1503@option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
32930e4e
L
1504@option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1505@option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1506@option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1507Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1508
cd6d6c15
NC
1509@end table
1510
ece2d90e 1511Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
252b5132
RH
1512
1513@kindex -(
1514@cindex groups of archives
1515@item -( @var{archives} -)
1516@itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1517The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1518either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1519
1520The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1521references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1522the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1523archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1524object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1525would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
5d3db3e2 1526they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
252b5132
RH
1527resolved.
1528
1529Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1530it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1531more archives.
1532
69da35b5
NC
1533@kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1534@kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1535@item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1536@itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1537Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
2ca22b03 1538recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
69da35b5
NC
1539and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1540the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1541behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1542so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1543restore the old behaviour.
2ca22b03 1544
4a43e768
AM
1545@kindex --as-needed
1546@kindex --no-as-needed
1547@item --as-needed
1548@itemx --no-as-needed
1549This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
ddbb8a31 1550on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
4a43e768
AM
1551the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1552on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
ddbb8a31 1553needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
ffa9430d
AM
1554emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1555non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1240be6b
AM
1556the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1557non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
ffa9430d
AM
1558Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1559the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1560needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1561from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
4a43e768 1562
6418520e
NC
1563Note: On Linux based systems the @option{--as-needed} option also has
1564an affect on the behaviour of the @option{--rpath} and
1565@option{--rpath-link} options. See the description of
1566@option{--rpath-link} for more details.
1567
e56f61be
L
1568@kindex --add-needed
1569@kindex --no-add-needed
1570@item --add-needed
1571@itemx --no-add-needed
ddbb8a31
NC
1572These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1573their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1574options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1575and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
e56f61be 1576
252b5132
RH
1577@kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1578@item -assert @var{keyword}
1579This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1580
1581@kindex -Bdynamic
1582@kindex -dy
1583@kindex -call_shared
1584@item -Bdynamic
1585@itemx -dy
1586@itemx -call_shared
1587Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1588for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1589default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1590for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1591multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
da8bce14 1592@option{-l} options which follow it.
252b5132 1593
a1ab1d2a
UD
1594@kindex -Bgroup
1595@item -Bgroup
1596Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1597section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1598object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
560e09e9
NC
1599@option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1600only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
a1ab1d2a 1601
252b5132
RH
1602@kindex -Bstatic
1603@kindex -dn
1604@kindex -non_shared
1605@kindex -static
a1ab1d2a 1606@item -Bstatic
252b5132
RH
1607@itemx -dn
1608@itemx -non_shared
1609@itemx -static
1610Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1611platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1612variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1613may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
560e09e9 1614library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
e9156f74
NC
1615option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1616option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1617shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1618references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
ece2d90e 1619libraries.
252b5132
RH
1620
1621@kindex -Bsymbolic
1622@item -Bsymbolic
1623When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1624definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1625for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1914e264
AM
1626within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1627platforms which support shared libraries.
252b5132 1628
40b36307
L
1629@kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1630@item -Bsymbolic-functions
1631When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
c0065db7 1632symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
40b36307 1633This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1914e264 1634libraries.
40b36307 1635
cf893b0e
FS
1636@kindex -Bno-symbolic
1637@item -Bno-symbolic
1638This option can cancel previously specified @samp{-Bsymbolic} and
1639@samp{-Bsymbolic-functions}.
1640
55255dae
L
1641@kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1642@item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1643Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1644typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1645global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1646within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1647to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1648in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1649which support shared libraries.
1650
1651The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1652scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1653
40b36307
L
1654@kindex --dynamic-list-data
1655@item --dynamic-list-data
1656Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1657
1658@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1659@item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1660Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1661is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1662
0b8a70d9
L
1663@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1664@item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1665Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1666
252b5132
RH
1667@kindex --check-sections
1668@kindex --no-check-sections
1669@item --check-sections
308b1ffd 1670@itemx --no-check-sections
252b5132 1671Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
7d816a17 1672been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
252b5132
RH
1673perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1674suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1675allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
a05a5b64 1676restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
02b0b1aa
NS
1677Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1678force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1679option.
252b5132 1680
ddbb8a31
NC
1681@kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1682@kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1683@item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1684@itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
9d5777a3 1685This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
ddbb8a31 1686by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
08efffb8 1687command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
ddbb8a31 1688output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
08efffb8 1689input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
ddbb8a31 1690specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
08efffb8
MM
1691follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1692behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
ddbb8a31
NC
1693
1694This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
08efffb8
MM
1695libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1696mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1697their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1698required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1699the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1700dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
ddbb8a31
NC
1701symbols.
1702
252b5132
RH
1703@cindex cross reference table
1704@kindex --cref
1705@item --cref
1706Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1707generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1708Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1709
1710The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1711easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1712sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1713symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
049c1c8e
NC
1714definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1715where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1716symbol are listed.
252b5132 1717
5dba6f05
NA
1718@cindex ctf variables
1719@kindex --ctf-variables
1720@kindex --no-ctf-variables
1721@item --ctf-variables
1722@item --no-ctf-variables
1723The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1724types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1725table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1726conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1727usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1728@option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1729The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1730
1731@cindex ctf type sharing
1732@kindex --ctf-share-types
1733@item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1734Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1735
1736@table @samp
1737@item share-unconflicted
1738Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1739where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1740translation unit. This is the default.
1741
1742@item share-duplicated
1743Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1744dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1745dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1746always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1747larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1748large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1749consumer at runtime.
1750@end table
1751
4818e05f
AM
1752@cindex common allocation
1753@kindex --no-define-common
1754@item --no-define-common
1755This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1756The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1757@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1758
1759The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1760the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1761of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1762forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1763Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1764from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1765This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1766and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1767duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1768paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1769
7bdf4127
AB
1770@cindex group allocation in linker script
1771@cindex section groups
1772@cindex COMDAT
1773@kindex --force-group-allocation
1774@item --force-group-allocation
1775This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1776normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1777default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1778change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1779command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1780effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1781
252b5132 1782@cindex symbols, from command line
2509a395
SL
1783@kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1784@item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
252b5132
RH
1785Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1786address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1787times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1788limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1789context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1790symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1791constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
66bc8739
AM
1792using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1793@emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1794equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
252b5132 1795
54874444
AB
1796The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1797in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1798symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1799placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1800the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1801consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1802@samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1803you are trying to achieve.
1804
252b5132 1805@cindex demangling, from command line
28c309a2 1806@kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132 1807@kindex --no-demangle
28c309a2 1808@item --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132
RH
1809@itemx --no-demangle
1810These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1811and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1812present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1813underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
a1ab1d2a
UD
1814mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1815different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1816to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
28c309a2
NC
1817demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1818is set. These options may be used to override the default.
252b5132
RH
1819
1820@cindex dynamic linker, from command line
506eee22 1821@kindex -I@var{file}
2509a395
SL
1822@kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1823@item -I@var{file}
1824@itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
252b5132
RH
1825Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1826generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1827linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1828doing.
1829
9b8b325a
RF
1830@kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1831@item --no-dynamic-linker
1832When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1833linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1834executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1835entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1836
a70f34c0
NC
1837@kindex --embedded-relocs
1838@item --embedded-relocs
1839This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
a094d01f 1840that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
a70f34c0
NC
1841is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1842targets.
1843
3f0a5f17
ME
1844@kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1845@item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1846Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1847in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1848
7ce691ae 1849@kindex --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd 1850@kindex --no-fatal-warnings
7ce691ae 1851@item --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd
NC
1852@itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1853Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1854with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
7ce691ae 1855
252b5132
RH
1856@kindex --force-exe-suffix
1857@item --force-exe-suffix
1858Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1859
1860If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1861@code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1862the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1863option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1864Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1865it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1866
1867@kindex --gc-sections
1868@kindex --no-gc-sections
1869@cindex garbage collection
c17d87de
NC
1870@item --gc-sections
1871@itemx --no-gc-sections
252b5132 1872Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
ac69cbc6 1873targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
b3549761 1874performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
0f088b2a
KT
1875@samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1876collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1877implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
252b5132 1878
d5465ba2
AM
1879@samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1880examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1881symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1882command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1883referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1884libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1885referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1886the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
b69e1ff3
CC
1887relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1888@samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
d5465ba2 1889
ac69cbc6 1890This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
9d5777a3 1891@samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
b69e1ff3
CC
1892specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1893@samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1894command in the linker script.
ac69cbc6 1895
99fabbc9
JL
1896As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
1897@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
1898
c17d87de
NC
1899@kindex --print-gc-sections
1900@kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1901@cindex garbage collection
1902@item --print-gc-sections
1903@itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1904List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1905printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1906collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1907default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1908be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1909line.
1910
22185505 1911@kindex --gc-keep-exported
1912@cindex garbage collection
1913@item --gc-keep-exported
1914When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1915collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1916default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1917executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1918collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1919Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1920it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1921ELF format targets.
1922
30824704
RM
1923@kindex --print-output-format
1924@cindex output format
1925@item --print-output-format
1926Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1927other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1928in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1929
3604cb1f
TG
1930@kindex --print-memory-usage
1931@cindex memory usage
1932@item --print-memory-usage
1933Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1934the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1935quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1936headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1937parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1938
1939@smallexample
1940Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1941 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
1942 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
1943@end smallexample
1944
252b5132
RH
1945@cindex help
1946@cindex usage
1947@kindex --help
1948@item --help
1949Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1950
ea20a7da
CC
1951@kindex --target-help
1952@item --target-help
a094d01f 1953Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
ea20a7da 1954
2509a395
SL
1955@kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1956@item -Map=@var{mapfile}
252b5132 1957Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
2c72361c
NC
1958@option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
1959@code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
1960
1961Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
1962written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
1963inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
1964file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
1965@code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
1966output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
1967@var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
1968
1969@smallexample
1970 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1971 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1972 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1973 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1974 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
1975 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1976 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
1977 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
1978 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
1979 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
1980@end smallexample
1981
1982It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
1983
1984If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
1985operation.
252b5132
RH
1986
1987@cindex memory usage
1988@kindex --no-keep-memory
1989@item --no-keep-memory
ff5dcc92
SC
1990@command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
1991symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
252b5132 1992instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
ff5dcc92 1993necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
252b5132
RH
1994while linking a large executable.
1995
1996@kindex --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 1997@kindex -z defs
97a232d7 1998@kindex -z undefs
252b5132 1999@item --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 2000@itemx -z defs
560e09e9
NC
2001Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
2002is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
2003The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
2004behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
ece2d90e 2005libraries being linked in.
252b5132 2006
97a232d7
NC
2007The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
2008
aa713662
L
2009@kindex --allow-multiple-definition
2010@kindex -z muldefs
2011@item --allow-multiple-definition
2012@itemx -z muldefs
2013Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
2014report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
2015first definition will be used.
2016
b79e8c78 2017@kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 2018@kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
b79e8c78 2019@item --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 2020@itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
903249d7 2021Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
560e09e9
NC
2022This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
2023determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
2024shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
2025how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
2026
903249d7
NC
2027The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
2028referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
2029an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
2030a shared library.
2031
2032The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
2033libraries specified at link time are that:
2034
2035@itemize @bullet
2036@item
2037A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
2038that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
2039resolvable at load time.
2040@item
2041There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
2042symbols in shared libraries are normal.
2043
2044The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
2045select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
2046architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
2047appropriate memset function.
2048@end itemize
b79e8c78 2049
23ae20f5
NC
2050@kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2051@item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2052If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
2053@var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
2054only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
2055libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
93cf38c0
NC
2056``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
2057undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
2058will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
23ae20f5
NC
2059might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
2060error message will be displayed.
2061
2062The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
2063switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
2064
31941635
L
2065@kindex --no-undefined-version
2066@item --no-undefined-version
2067Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
2068it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
2069will be issued instead.
2070
3e3b46e5
PB
2071@kindex --default-symver
2072@item --default-symver
2073Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
fc0e6df6
PB
2074exported symbols.
2075
2076@kindex --default-imported-symver
2077@item --default-imported-symver
2078Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2079imported symbols.
3e3b46e5 2080
252b5132
RH
2081@kindex --no-warn-mismatch
2082@item --no-warn-mismatch
ff5dcc92 2083Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
252b5132
RH
2084files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
2085been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
ff5dcc92 2086This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
252b5132
RH
2087errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2088have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2089inappropriate.
2090
fe7929ce
AM
2091@kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2092@item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2093Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2094library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2095
252b5132
RH
2096@kindex --no-whole-archive
2097@item --no-whole-archive
ff5dcc92 2098Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
252b5132
RH
2099archive files.
2100
2101@cindex output file after errors
2102@kindex --noinhibit-exec
2103@item --noinhibit-exec
2104Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2105Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2106errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2107when it issues any error whatsoever.
2108
0a9c1c8e
CD
2109@kindex -nostdlib
2110@item -nostdlib
2111Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2112command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2113(including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2114
252b5132 2115@ifclear SingleFormat
2509a395
SL
2116@kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2117@item --oformat=@var{output-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
2118@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2119file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 2120@samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
ff5dcc92
SC
2121object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2122object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
2123should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2124usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2125name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2126list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2127command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2128this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2129@end ifclear
2130
76359541
TP
2131@kindex --out-implib
2132@item --out-implib @var{file}
2133Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2134the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2135library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2136may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2137behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2138step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2139the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2140
36af4a4e
JJ
2141@kindex -pie
2142@kindex --pic-executable
2143@item -pie
2144@itemx --pic-executable
2145@cindex position independent executables
2146Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2147ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2148libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
7e7d5768 2149address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
36af4a4e
JJ
2150normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2151defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2152
e8f6c2a5
FS
2153@kindex -no-pie
2154@item -no-pie
2155@cindex position dependent executables
2156Create a position dependent executable. This is the default.
2157
252b5132
RH
2158@kindex -qmagic
2159@item -qmagic
2160This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2161
2162@kindex -Qy
2163@item -Qy
2164This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2165
2166@kindex --relax
2167@cindex synthesizing linker
2168@cindex relaxing addressing modes
28d5f677 2169@cindex --no-relax
252b5132 2170@item --relax
28d5f677 2171@itemx --no-relax
a1ab1d2a 2172An option with machine dependent effects.
252b5132
RH
2173@ifset GENERIC
2174This option is only supported on a few targets.
2175@end ifset
2176@ifset H8300
ff5dcc92 2177@xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
252b5132 2178@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
2179@ifset XTENSA
2180@xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2181@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
2182@ifset M68HC11
2183@xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2184@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
2185@ifset NIOSII
2186@xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2187@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
2188@ifset POWERPC
2189@xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2190@end ifset
252b5132 2191
ccd9fae5 2192On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
28d5f677
NC
2193global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2194addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2195synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
11e7fd74 2196instructions, and combining constant values.
252b5132
RH
2197
2198On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2199debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2200@ifset GENERIC
28d5f677
NC
2201This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2202family of processors.
252b5132
RH
2203@end ifset
2204
ccd9fae5
NC
2205On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2206@option{--no-relax} will disable it.
28d5f677 2207
ccd9fae5
NC
2208On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2209and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2210
252b5132
RH
2211@cindex retaining specified symbols
2212@cindex stripping all but some symbols
2213@cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2509a395
SL
2214@kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2215@item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
252b5132
RH
2216Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2217discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2218symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2219@ifset GENERIC
2220(such as VxWorks)
2221@end ifset
2222where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2223run-time memory.
2224
2225@samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2226or symbols needed for relocations.
2227
2228You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2229line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2230
2231@ifset GENERIC
2509a395 2232@item -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2233@cindex runtime library search path
2509a395 2234@kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2235Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
ff5dcc92 2236linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
252b5132 2237arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
c1b00498
MR
2238them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2239
2240The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2241are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2242description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2243in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2244have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2245
2246If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2247contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2248is defined.
252b5132 2249
ff5dcc92 2250The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
d8506323 2251SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
ff5dcc92
SC
2252@option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2253runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2254options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2255gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
b45619c0 2256file systems.
252b5132 2257
ff5dcc92 2258For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 2259followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 2260the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
2261@end ifset
2262
2263@ifset GENERIC
2264@cindex link-time runtime library search path
2509a395
SL
2265@kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2266@item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
252b5132
RH
2267When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2268happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2269of the input files.
2270
2271When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2272non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2273shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
ff5dcc92 2274explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
252b5132 2275specifies the first set of directories to search. The
ff5dcc92 2276@option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
252b5132
RH
2277either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2278appearing multiple times.
2279
e680a6b6
NC
2280The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2281directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2282containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2283and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
228464-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2285
2286The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2287@var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2288supported.
2289
28c309a2
NC
2290This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2291that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2292is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2293runtime linker would do.
2294
252b5132 2295The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
ece2d90e 2296libraries:
d8e4137b 2297
252b5132
RH
2298@enumerate
2299@item
ff5dcc92 2300Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
252b5132 2301@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2302Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2303between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2304specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2305used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
ece2d90e
NC
2306at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2307by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2308the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
252b5132 2309@item
e2a83dd0
NC
2310On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2311@option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2312environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
252b5132 2313@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2314On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2315directories specified using @option{-L} options.
252b5132 2316@item
a1b8d843 2317For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
e2a83dd0 2318variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
252b5132 2319@item
ec4eb78a
L
2320For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2321@code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2322libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2323@code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2324@item
d8e4137b
NC
2325For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2326exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2327to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2328defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2329configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2330@item
2331For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2332the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2333header file.
2334@item
364d7729
AM
2335Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a
2336linker script given on the command line, including scripts specified
2337by @option{-T} (but not @option{-dT}).
2338@item
2339The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2340@item
2341Any directories specified by a plugin LDPT_SET_EXTRA_LIBRARY_PATH.
2342@item
2343Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a default
2344linker script.
252b5132
RH
2345@end enumerate
2346
6418520e
NC
2347Note however on Linux based systems there is an additional caveat: If
2348the @option{--as-needed} option is active @emph{and} a shared library
2349is located which would normally satisfy the search @emph{and} this
2350library does not have DT_NEEDED tag for @file{libc.so}
2351@emph{and} there is a shared library later on in the set of search
2352directories which also satisfies the search @emph{and}
2353this second shared library does have a DT_NEEDED tag for
2354@file{libc.so} @emph{then} the second library will be selected instead
2355of the first.
2356
252b5132
RH
2357If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2358warning and continue with the link.
6418520e 2359
252b5132
RH
2360@end ifset
2361
2362@kindex -shared
2363@kindex -Bshareable
2364@item -shared
2365@itemx -Bshareable
2366@cindex shared libraries
2367Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2368and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
ff5dcc92 2369shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
252b5132
RH
2370undefined symbols in the link.
2371
252b5132 2372@kindex --sort-common
2509a395
SL
2373@item --sort-common
2374@itemx --sort-common=ascending
2375@itemx --sort-common=descending
de7dd2bd
NC
2376This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2377ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2378sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2379eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2380between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2381specified, then descending order is assumed.
252b5132 2382
2509a395
SL
2383@kindex --sort-section=name
2384@item --sort-section=name
bcaa7b3e
L
2385This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2386patterns in the linker script.
2387
2509a395
SL
2388@kindex --sort-section=alignment
2389@item --sort-section=alignment
bcaa7b3e
L
2390This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2391patterns in the linker script.
2392
a70f34c0
NC
2393@kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2394@item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2395This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2396.dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2397post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2398
252b5132 2399@kindex --split-by-file
2509a395 2400@item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
ff5dcc92 2401Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
a854a4a7
AM
2402each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2403size of 1 if not given.
252b5132
RH
2404
2405@kindex --split-by-reloc
2509a395 2406@item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
a854a4a7 2407Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
252b5132 2408output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
a854a4a7 2409This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
252b5132
RH
2410certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2411cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2412that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2413support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2414input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2415more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
a854a4a7 2416many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
252b5132
RH
2417
2418@kindex --stats
2419@item --stats
2420Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2421as execution time and memory usage.
2422
2509a395 2423@kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
e2243057
RS
2424@item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2425Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2426configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2427that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2428
a70f34c0
NC
2429@kindex --task-link
2430@item --task-link
2431This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2432file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2433
252b5132
RH
2434@kindex --traditional-format
2435@cindex traditional format
2436@item --traditional-format
ff5dcc92
SC
2437For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2438the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
252b5132
RH
2439use the traditional format instead.
2440
2441@cindex dbx
ff5dcc92 2442For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
252b5132
RH
2443symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2444full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2445@code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
ff5dcc92 2446trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
252b5132
RH
2447combine duplicate entries.
2448
2509a395
SL
2449@kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2450@item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
176355da
NC
2451Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2452address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2453times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2454line.
2455@var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2456for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2457@samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2458should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2459sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2460
2509a395
SL
2461@kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2462@kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2463@kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
252b5132 2464@cindex segment origins, cmd line
2509a395
SL
2465@item -Tbss=@var{org}
2466@itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2467@itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2468Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
a6e02871 2469@code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
252b5132 2470
2509a395
SL
2471@kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2472@item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
258795f5 2473@cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2b8c06a3
L
2474When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2475byte of the text segment.
258795f5 2476
9d5777a3
RM
2477@kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2478@item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2479@cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2480When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2481the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2482text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2483
0d705e9f
AM
2484@kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2485@item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2486@cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2487When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2488model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2489
560e09e9
NC
2490@kindex --unresolved-symbols
2491@item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2492Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2493values for @samp{method}:
2494
2495@table @samp
2496@item ignore-all
da8bce14 2497Do not report any unresolved symbols.
560e09e9
NC
2498
2499@item report-all
da8bce14 2500Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
560e09e9
NC
2501
2502@item ignore-in-object-files
2503Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2504ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2505
2506@item ignore-in-shared-libs
2507Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2508ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2509when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2510libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2511command line.
2512@end table
2513
2514The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2515by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2516
2517Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2518unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2519can change this to a warning.
2520
1715a13c
L
2521@kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2522@cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
252b5132 2523@item --dll-verbose
1715a13c 2524@itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
ff5dcc92 2525Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
252b5132 2526supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
1715a13c
L
2527the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2528argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
252b5132
RH
2529
2530@kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2531@cindex version script, symbol versions
2509a395 2532@item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
252b5132
RH
2533Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2534used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
36f63dca 2535about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
09e2aba4
DK
2536is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2537see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2538use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2539symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2540@xref{WIN32}.
252b5132 2541
7ce691ae 2542@kindex --warn-common
252b5132
RH
2543@cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2544@cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2545@item --warn-common
2546Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
11e7fd74 2547a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
252b5132
RH
2548but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2549you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
11e7fd74 2550Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
252b5132
RH
2551warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2552
2553There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2554
2555@table @samp
2556@item int i = 1;
2557A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2558file.
2559
2560@item extern int i;
2561An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2562There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2563variable somewhere.
2564
2565@item int i;
2566A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2567variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2568The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2569single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2570size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2571a definition of the same variable.
2572@end table
2573
2574The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2575Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2576just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2577encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2578a common symbol.
2579
2580@enumerate
2581@item
2582Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2583definition for the symbol.
2584@smallexample
2585@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2586 overridden by definition
2587@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2588@end smallexample
2589
2590@item
2591Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2592the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2593except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2594@smallexample
2595@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2596 overriding common
2597@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2598@end smallexample
2599
2600@item
2601Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2602@smallexample
2603@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2604 of `@var{symbol}'
2605@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2606@end smallexample
2607
2608@item
2609Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2610@smallexample
2611@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2612 overridden by larger common
2613@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2614@end smallexample
2615
2616@item
2617Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2618the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2619encountered in a different order.
2620@smallexample
2621@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2622 overriding smaller common
2623@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2624@end smallexample
2625@end enumerate
2626
2627@kindex --warn-constructors
2628@item --warn-constructors
2629Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2630object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2631detect the use of global constructors.
2632
2633@kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2634@item --warn-multiple-gp
2635Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2636This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2637Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2638section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2639of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2640base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2641base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2642bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2643large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2644values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2645option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2646
2647@kindex --warn-once
2648@cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2649@cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2650@item --warn-once
2651Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2652which refers to it.
2653
2654@kindex --warn-section-align
2655@cindex warnings, on section alignment
2656@cindex section alignment, warnings on
2657@item --warn-section-align
2658Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2659alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2660The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2661is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2662the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2663
a6dbf402
L
2664@kindex --warn-textrel
2665@item --warn-textrel
2666Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2667or shared object.
8fdd7217 2668
a0c402a5
L
2669@kindex --warn-alternate-em
2670@item --warn-alternate-em
2671Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2672
560e09e9
NC
2673@kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2674@item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2675If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2676@option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2677This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2678
2679@kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2680@item --error-unresolved-symbols
2681This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2682it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2683
252b5132
RH
2684@kindex --whole-archive
2685@cindex including an entire archive
2686@item --whole-archive
2687For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
ff5dcc92 2688@option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
252b5132
RH
2689in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2690files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2691library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2692library. This option may be used more than once.
2693
7ec229ce 2694Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
ff5dcc92
SC
2695about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2696Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
7ec229ce
DD
2697list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2698your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2699
2509a395
SL
2700@kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2701@item --wrap=@var{symbol}
252b5132
RH
2702Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2703@var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2704undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2705@var{symbol}.
2706
2707This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2708wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2709wishes to call the system function, it should call
2710@code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2711
2712Here is a trivial example:
2713
2714@smallexample
2715void *
cc2f008e 2716__wrap_malloc (size_t c)
252b5132 2717@{
cc2f008e 2718 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
252b5132
RH
2719 return __real_malloc (c);
2720@}
2721@end smallexample
2722
ff5dcc92 2723If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
252b5132
RH
2724all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2725instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2726call the real @code{malloc} function.
2727
2728You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
ff5dcc92 2729links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
252b5132
RH
2730you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2731file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2732call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2733
4ea904ed
SH
2734Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2735internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2736@code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2737@code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2738
2739@smallexample
2740int
2741f (void)
2742@{
2743 return 123;
2744@}
2745
2746int
2747g (void)
2748@{
2749 return f();
2750@}
2751@end smallexample
2752
6aa29e7b 2753@kindex --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b 2754@kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
6aa29e7b 2755@item --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b
NC
2756@itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2757Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2758(@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2759section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
6aa29e7b 2760
e41b3a13
JJ
2761@kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2762@item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2763Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2764generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2765if linker generated unwind info is supported.
2766
6c1439be
L
2767@kindex --enable-new-dtags
2768@kindex --disable-new-dtags
2769@item --enable-new-dtags
2770@itemx --disable-new-dtags
2771This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2772systems may not understand them. If you specify
b1b00fcc
MF
2773@option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2774and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
ff5dcc92 2775If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
6c1439be
L
2776created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2777those options are only available for ELF systems.
2778
2d643429 2779@kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
e185dd51 2780@item --hash-size=@var{number}
2d643429
NC
2781Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2782close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2783time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2784increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2785value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2786
fdc90cb4
JJ
2787@kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2788@item --hash-style=@var{style}
2789Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2790@code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2791new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2792the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
c8455dc9
NC
2793hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2794but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
fdc90cb4 2795
0ce398f1
L
2796@kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2797@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2798@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2799@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2800@item --compress-debug-sections=none
2801@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2802@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2803@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
9af89fba
NC
2804On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2805compressed using zlib.
2806
2807@option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2808sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2809DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2810instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2811also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2812sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2813
2814The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2815@option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2816
2817Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2818sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2819for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2820uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2821
2822The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2823involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2824default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2825@option{--help} option.
0ce398f1 2826
35835446
JR
2827@kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2828@item --reduce-memory-overheads
2829This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
f2a8f148 2830linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
35835446 2831for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2d643429
NC
2832about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2833
4f9c04f7 2834Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2d643429 28351021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
a85785bc 2836run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2d643429
NC
2837has been used.
2838
2839The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2840enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
35835446 2841
c0065db7
RM
2842@kindex --build-id
2843@kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2844@item --build-id
2845@itemx --build-id=@var{style}
61e2488c 2846Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
6033bf41 2847or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
61e2488c
JT
2848unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2849@code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2850@sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2851@code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2852the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2853string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2854@code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2855is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
24382dca
RM
2856
2857The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2858that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2859unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2860to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2861file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2862string identifying the original linked file does not change.
c0065db7
RM
2863
2864Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2865@code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
252b5132
RH
2866@end table
2867
0285c67d
NC
2868@c man end
2869
36f63dca 2870@subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
252b5132 2871
0285c67d
NC
2872@c man begin OPTIONS
2873
ff5dcc92 2874The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
252b5132
RH
2875the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2876normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2877use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2878@code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2879like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2880symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2881object file).
2882
2883In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
a05a5b64 2884support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
252b5132
RH
2885PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
2886values by either a space or an equals sign.
2887
ff5dcc92 2888@table @gcctabopt
252b5132
RH
2889
2890@kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2891@item --add-stdcall-alias
2892If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2893as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
bb10df36 2894[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2895
2896@kindex --base-file
2897@item --base-file @var{file}
2898Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2899addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2900@file{dlltool}.
bb10df36 2901[This is an i386 PE specific option]
252b5132
RH
2902
2903@kindex --dll
2904@item --dll
2905Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
ff5dcc92 2906@option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
252b5132 2907file.
bb10df36 2908[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2909
88183869
DK
2910@kindex --enable-long-section-names
2911@kindex --disable-long-section-names
2912@item --enable-long-section-names
2913@itemx --disable-long-section-names
56e6cf80 2914The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
88183869 2915the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
56e6cf80
NC
2916for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
2917fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
88183869
DK
2918to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
2919allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
2920disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
2921generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
2922as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
9d5777a3
RM
2923with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
2924GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3efd345c
DK
2925information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
2926option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
2927section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
2928when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
2929image and not stripping symbols.
88183869
DK
2930[This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
2931
252b5132
RH
2932@kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
2933@kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
2934@item --enable-stdcall-fixup
2935@itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
2936If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
36f63dca 2937do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
252b5132
RH
2938only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
2939resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
2940undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
2941@code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
2942to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
2943warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
2944import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
ff5dcc92 2945to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
252b5132 2946feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
ff5dcc92 2947@option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
252b5132 2948mismatches are considered to be errors.
bb10df36 2949[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2950
522f09cd
KT
2951@kindex --leading-underscore
2952@kindex --no-leading-underscore
2953@item --leading-underscore
2954@itemx --no-leading-underscore
2955For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
2956in target's description. By this option it is possible to
2957disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
2958
252b5132
RH
2959@cindex DLLs, creating
2960@kindex --export-all-symbols
2961@item --export-all-symbols
2962If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
2963be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
2964otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
2965explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
2966attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
2967option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
ece2d90e 2968@code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
b044cda1 2969@code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
ece2d90e
NC
2970exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
2971re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
2972such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
2973@code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
b044cda1
CW
2974@code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
2975Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
2976not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
ece2d90e 2977extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
b044cda1 2978(obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
ece2d90e 2979These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
b044cda1 2980@code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
ece2d90e 2981@code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
b044cda1 2982@code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
ece2d90e 2983@code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
bb10df36 2984[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2985
2986@kindex --exclude-symbols
1d0a3c9c 2987@item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
252b5132
RH
2988Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
2989exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
bb10df36 2990[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2991
2927aaca
NC
2992@kindex --exclude-all-symbols
2993@item --exclude-all-symbols
2994Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
2995[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2996
252b5132
RH
2997@kindex --file-alignment
2998@item --file-alignment
2999Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
3000file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
3001512.
bb10df36 3002[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3003
3004@cindex heap size
3005@kindex --heap
3006@item --heap @var{reserve}
3007@itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3008Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3009to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3010committed.
bb10df36 3011[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3012
3013@cindex image base
3014@kindex --image-base
3015@item --image-base @var{value}
3016Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
3017the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
3018is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
3019your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
3020other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
3021for dlls.
bb10df36 3022[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3023
3024@kindex --kill-at
3025@item --kill-at
3026If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
3027symbols before they are exported.
bb10df36 3028[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3029
26d2d8a2
BF
3030@kindex --large-address-aware
3031@item --large-address-aware
b45619c0 3032If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
26d2d8a2 3033header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
b45619c0 3034greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
26d2d8a2
BF
3035or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
3036section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
3037[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3038
f69a2f97
NC
3039@kindex --disable-large-address-aware
3040@item --disable-large-address-aware
3041Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
3042This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
3043driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
3044addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
3045[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3046
252b5132
RH
3047@kindex --major-image-version
3048@item --major-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3049Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
bb10df36 3050[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3051
3052@kindex --major-os-version
3053@item --major-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3054Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3055[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3056
3057@kindex --major-subsystem-version
3058@item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3059Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3060[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3061
3062@kindex --minor-image-version
3063@item --minor-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3064Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3065[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3066
3067@kindex --minor-os-version
3068@item --minor-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3069Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3070[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3071
3072@kindex --minor-subsystem-version
3073@item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3074Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3075[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3076
3077@cindex DEF files, creating
3078@cindex DLLs, creating
3079@kindex --output-def
3080@item --output-def @var{file}
3081The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
3082file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
3083(which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
3084library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
3085automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
bb10df36 3086[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3087
b044cda1 3088@cindex DLLs, creating
b044cda1
CW
3089@kindex --enable-auto-image-base
3090@item --enable-auto-image-base
d0e6d77b
CF
3091@itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
3092Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
3093@var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
3094By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
3095for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
3096execution are avoided.
bb10df36 3097[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3098
3099@kindex --disable-auto-image-base
3100@item --disable-auto-image-base
3101Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
3102user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
3103default.
bb10df36 3104[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3105
3106@cindex DLLs, linking to
3107@kindex --dll-search-prefix
3108@item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
489d0400 3109When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
ece2d90e 3110search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
560e09e9 3111@code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
b044cda1
CW
3112between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3113uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
ece2d90e 3114@code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
bb10df36 3115[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3116
3117@kindex --enable-auto-import
3118@item --enable-auto-import
ece2d90e 3119Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
317ff008
EB
3120DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3121mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3122[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3123
3124The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3125feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3126
3127Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3128of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3129PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
4d8907ac 3130
e2a83dd0
NC
3131Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3132data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3133placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3134around a problem with consts that is described here:
3135http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3136
4d8907ac
DS
3137Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3138see this message:
0d888aac 3139
ece2d90e 3140"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
0d888aac
CW
3141documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3142
ece2d90e
NC
3143This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3144ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
c0065db7
RM
3145allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3146fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3147constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
2f8d8971
NC
3148multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3149this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3150of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3151the warning, and exit.
3152
3153There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3154data type of the exported variable:
0d888aac 3155
2fa9fc65
NC
3156One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3157of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
560e09e9 3158this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
2fa9fc65 3159
c0065db7
RM
3160A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3161that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3162there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
0d888aac
CW
3163a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3164
3165@example
3166extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3167extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3168 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3169@end example
3170
3171or
3172
3173@example
3174extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3175extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3176 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3177@end example
3178
c0065db7 3179For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
2f8d8971 3180is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
0d888aac
CW
3181
3182@example
3183extern struct s extern_struct;
c0065db7 3184extern_struct.field -->
0d888aac
CW
3185 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3186@end example
3187
c406afaf
NC
3188or
3189
3190@example
3191extern long long extern_ll;
3192extern_ll -->
3193 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3194@end example
3195
2fa9fc65 3196A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
c0065db7 3197'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
11e7fd74 3198@code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
0d888aac 3199requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
c0065db7
RM
3200building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3201merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3202between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
0d888aac
CW
3203constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3204
3205Original:
3206@example
3207--foo.h
3208extern int arr[];
3209--foo.c
3210#include "foo.h"
3211void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3212 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3213@}
3214@end example
3215
3216Solution 1:
3217@example
3218--foo.h
3219extern int arr[];
3220--foo.c
3221#include "foo.h"
3222void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3223 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3224 volatile int *parr = arr;
3225 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3226@}
3227@end example
3228
3229Solution 2:
3230@example
3231--foo.h
3232/* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3233#if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3234 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3235#define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3236#else
3237#define FOO_IMPORT
3238#endif
3239extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3240--foo.c
3241#include "foo.h"
3242void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3243 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3244@}
3245@end example
3246
c0065db7 3247A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
0d888aac
CW
3248library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3249for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3250functions).
b044cda1
CW
3251
3252@kindex --disable-auto-import
3253@item --disable-auto-import
c0065db7 3254Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
b044cda1 3255@code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3256[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3257
2fa9fc65
NC
3258@kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3259@item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3260If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3261that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3262a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
c0065db7 3263environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
bb10df36 3264[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65
NC
3265
3266@kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3267@item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
317ff008 3268Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3269[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65 3270
b044cda1
CW
3271@kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3272@item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3273Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
bb10df36 3274[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3275
252b5132
RH
3276@kindex --section-alignment
3277@item --section-alignment
3278Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3279addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
bb10df36 3280[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3281
3282@cindex stack size
3283@kindex --stack
3284@item --stack @var{reserve}
3285@itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3286Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3287to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3288committed.
bb10df36 3289[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3290
3291@kindex --subsystem
3292@item --subsystem @var{which}
3293@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3294@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3295Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3296legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
33f362e1
NC
3297@code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3298the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3299@var{which}.
bb10df36 3300[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3301
2f563b51
DK
3302The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3303of the PE file header:
3304[These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3305
2d5c3743
NC
3306@kindex --high-entropy-va
3307@item --high-entropy-va
514b4e19 3308@itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
2d5c3743 3309Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
514b4e19
JD
3310(ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3311
dc9bd8c9
HD
3312This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3313@option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2d5c3743 3314
2f563b51
DK
3315@kindex --dynamicbase
3316@item --dynamicbase
514b4e19 3317@itemx --disable-dynamicbase
2f563b51
DK
3318The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3319randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
514b4e19
JD
3320Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3321can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
dc9bd8c9 3322This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2f563b51
DK
3323
3324@kindex --forceinteg
3325@item --forceinteg
514b4e19
JD
3326@itemx --disable-forceinteg
3327Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3328default.
2f563b51
DK
3329
3330@kindex --nxcompat
3331@item --nxcompat
514b4e19 3332@item --disable-nxcompat
2f563b51 3333The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
514b4e19
JD
3334This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3335targets. The option is enabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3336
3337@kindex --no-isolation
3338@item --no-isolation
514b4e19 3339@itemx --disable-no-isolation
2f563b51 3340Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
514b4e19 3341This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3342
3343@kindex --no-seh
3344@item --no-seh
514b4e19 3345@itemx --disable-no-seh
2f563b51 3346The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
514b4e19 3347this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3348
3349@kindex --no-bind
3350@item --no-bind
514b4e19
JD
3351@itemx --disable-no-bind
3352Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3353
3354@kindex --wdmdriver
3355@item --wdmdriver
514b4e19
JD
3356@itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3357The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3358by default.
9d5777a3 3359
2f563b51
DK
3360@kindex --tsaware
3361@item --tsaware
514b4e19
JD
3362@itemx --disable-tsaware
3363The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3364default.
2f563b51 3365
0cb112f7
CF
3366@kindex --insert-timestamp
3367@item --insert-timestamp
eeb14e5a
LZ
3368@itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3369Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3370as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3371other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
56e6cf80 3372will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
eeb14e5a
LZ
3373same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3374can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
56e6cf80 3375that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
eeb14e5a 3376identically.
dc9bd8c9
HD
3377
3378@kindex --enable-reloc-section
3379@item --enable-reloc-section
514b4e19 3380@itemx --disable-reloc-section
dc9bd8c9
HD
3381Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3382is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
514b4e19 3383This option is enabled by default.
252b5132
RH
3384@end table
3385
0285c67d
NC
3386@c man end
3387
ac145307
BS
3388@ifset C6X
3389@subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3390
3391@c man begin OPTIONS
3392
3393The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3394libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3395all executables use an index of 0.
3396
3397@table @gcctabopt
3398
3399@kindex --dsbt-size
3400@item --dsbt-size @var{size}
56e6cf80 3401This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
ac145307
BS
3402or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3403entries.
3404
3405@kindex --dsbt-index
3406@item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3407This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3408to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3409executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3410@code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3411
fbd9ad90
PB
3412@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3413The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3414exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3415
ac145307
BS
3416@end table
3417
3418@c man end
3419@end ifset
3420
b8891f8d
AJ
3421@ifset CSKY
3422@subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3423
3424@c man begin OPTIONS
3425
3426@table @gcctabopt
3427
3428@kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3429@item --branch-stub
3430This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3431sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3432usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3433can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3434the compiler or assembler.
3435
3436@kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3437@item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3438This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3439It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3440be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3441stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3442sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3443@samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3444linker should choose suitable defaults.
3445
3446@end table
3447
3448@c man end
3449@end ifset
3450
93fd0973
SC
3451@ifset M68HC11
3452@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3453
3454@c man begin OPTIONS
3455
3456The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3457memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3458
3459@table @gcctabopt
3460
3461@kindex --no-trampoline
3462@item --no-trampoline
3463This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3464is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3465instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3466
3467@kindex --bank-window
3468@item --bank-window @var{name}
3469This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3470the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3471The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3472paging and addresses within the memory window.
3473
3474@end table
3475
3476@c man end
3477@end ifset
3478
7fb9f789
NC
3479@ifset M68K
3480@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3481
3482@c man begin OPTIONS
3483
3484The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3485when linking for 68K targets.
3486
3487@table @gcctabopt
3488
3489@kindex --got
3490@item --got=@var{type}
3491This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3492@var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3493@samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3494Info entry for @file{ld}.
3495
3496@end table
3497
3498@c man end
3499@end ifset
3500
833794fc
MR
3501@ifset MIPS
3502@subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3503
3504@c man begin OPTIONS
3505
3506The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
8b10b0b3
MR
3507generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3508linking for MIPS targets.
833794fc
MR
3509
3510@table @gcctabopt
3511
3512@kindex --insn32
3513@item --insn32
3514@kindex --no-insn32
3515@itemx --no-insn32
3516These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3517generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3518or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
351932-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3520used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3521possible.
3522
8b10b0b3
MR
3523@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3524@item --ignore-branch-isa
3525@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3526@itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3527These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3528transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3529accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3530is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3531instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3532equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3533calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3534a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3535an error.
3536
3734320d
MF
3537@kindex --compact-branches
3538@item --compact-branches
3539@kindex --no-compact-branches
fa1477dc 3540@itemx --no-compact-branches
3734320d
MF
3541These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3542in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3543
833794fc
MR
3544@end table
3545
3546@c man end
3547@end ifset
3548
fa1477dc
SC
3549
3550@ifset PDP11
3551@subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3552
3553@c man begin OPTIONS
3554
3555For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3556produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3557for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3558targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3559defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3560here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3561
3562@table @gcctabopt
3563
3564@kindex -N
3565@item -N
3566@kindex --omagic
3567@itemx --omagic
3568
3569Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3570indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3571shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3572writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3573the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3574programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3575from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3576
3577@kindex -n
3578@item -n
3579@kindex --nmagic
3580@itemx --nmagic
3581
3582Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3583indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3584be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3585file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3586byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3587a @emph{pure executable} format.
3588
3589@kindex -z
3590@item -z
3591@kindex --imagic
3592@itemx --imagic
3593
3594Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3595indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3596data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3597instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3598larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3599to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3600shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3601option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3602and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3603this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3604executable} format.
3605
3606@kindex --no-omagic
3607@item --no-omagic
3608
3609Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3610
3611@end table
3612
3613@c man end
3614@end ifset
3615
252b5132
RH
3616@ifset UsesEnvVars
3617@node Environment
3618@section Environment Variables
3619
0285c67d
NC
3620@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3621
560e09e9 3622You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
36f63dca
NC
3623@ifclear SingleFormat
3624@code{GNUTARGET},
3625@end ifclear
3626@code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
252b5132 3627
36f63dca 3628@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
3629@kindex GNUTARGET
3630@cindex default input format
3631@code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3632use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3633of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
ff5dcc92 3634@code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
252b5132
RH
3635of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3636attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3637this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3638there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3639object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3640BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3641in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
36f63dca 3642@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
3643
3644@kindex LDEMULATION
3645@cindex default emulation
3646@cindex emulation, default
3647@code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3648@samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3649behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3650available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3651the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3652variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3653linker was configured.
252b5132
RH
3654
3655@kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3656@cindex demangling, default
3657Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3658@code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3659default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3660a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3661may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3662options.
3663
0285c67d
NC
3664@c man end
3665@end ifset
3666
252b5132
RH
3667@node Scripts
3668@chapter Linker Scripts
3669
3670@cindex scripts
3671@cindex linker scripts
3672@cindex command files
3673Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3674written in the linker command language.
3675
3676The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3677the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3678the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3679more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3680direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3681described below.
3682
3683The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3684yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
a05a5b64
TP
3685linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3686to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
252b5132
RH
3687such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3688
3689You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3690line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3691default linker script.
3692
3693You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3694to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3695Linker Scripts}.
3696
3697@menu
3698* Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3699* Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3700* Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3701* Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3702* Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3703* SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3704* MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3705* PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3706* VERSION:: VERSION Command
3707* Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3708* Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3709@end menu
3710
3711@node Basic Script Concepts
3712@section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3713@cindex linker script concepts
3714We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3715describe the linker script language.
3716
3717The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3718file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3719@dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3720The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3721purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3722among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3723section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3724in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3725
3726Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3727also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
56dd11f0 3728contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
252b5132
RH
3729the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3730A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3731area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3732loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3733which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3734of debugging information.
3735
3736Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3737first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3738the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3739@dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3740section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3741same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3742is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3743(this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3744based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3745RAM address would be the VMA.
3746
3747You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3748program with the @samp{-h} option.
3749
3750Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3751@dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3752has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3753information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3754will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3755static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3756referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3757
3758You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3759program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3760option.
3761
3762@node Script Format
3763@section Linker Script Format
3764@cindex linker script format
3765Linker scripts are text files.
3766
3767You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3768either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3769symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3770generally ignored.
3771
3772Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3773If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3774otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3775double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3776file name.
3777
3778You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3779@samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3780to whitespace.
3781
3782@node Simple Example
3783@section Simple Linker Script Example
3784@cindex linker script example
3785@cindex example of linker script
3786Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3787
3788The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3789@samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3790memory layout of the output file.
3791
3792The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3793describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3794code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3795@samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3796Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3797your input files.
3798
3799For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
38000x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3801linker script which will do that:
3802@smallexample
3803SECTIONS
3804@{
3805 . = 0x10000;
3806 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3807 . = 0x8000000;
3808 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3809 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3810@}
3811@end smallexample
3812
3813You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3814followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3815descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3816
252b5132
RH
3817The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3818sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3819counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3820other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3821current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3822incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3823@samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3824
3825The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3826required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3827after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3828which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3829wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3830means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3831
3832Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3833@samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3834@samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3835
3836The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3837the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3838at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3839output section, the value of the location counter will be
3840@samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3841effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
58434bc1 3842immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
252b5132
RH
3843
3844The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3845alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3846example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3847sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3848may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3849sections.
3850
3851That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3852
3853@node Simple Commands
3854@section Simple Linker Script Commands
3855@cindex linker script simple commands
3856In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3857
3858@menu
3859* Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3860* File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3861@ifclear SingleFormat
3862* Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3863@end ifclear
3864
4a93e180 3865* REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
252b5132
RH
3866* Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3867@end menu
3868
3869@node Entry Point
36f63dca 3870@subsection Setting the Entry Point
252b5132
RH
3871@kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3872@cindex start of execution
3873@cindex first instruction
3874@cindex entry point
3875The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3876point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3877entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
3878@smallexample
3879ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3880@end smallexample
3881
3882There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
3883entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3884stopping when one of them succeeds:
3885@itemize @bullet
a1ab1d2a 3886@item
252b5132 3887the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
a1ab1d2a 3888@item
252b5132 3889the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
a1ab1d2a 3890@item
a094d01f 3891the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
8a758655 3892targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3ab904c4 3893check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
a1ab1d2a 3894@item
252b5132 3895the address of the first byte of the @samp{.text} section, if present;
a1ab1d2a 3896@item
252b5132
RH
3897The address @code{0}.
3898@end itemize
3899
3900@node File Commands
36f63dca 3901@subsection Commands Dealing with Files
252b5132
RH
3902@cindex linker script file commands
3903Several linker script commands deal with files.
3904
3905@table @code
3906@item INCLUDE @var{filename}
3907@kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
3908@cindex including a linker script
3909Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
3910be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
ff5dcc92 3911with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
252b5132
RH
391210 levels deep.
3913
4006703d
NS
3914You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
3915@code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
3916
252b5132
RH
3917@item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3918@itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3919@kindex INPUT(@var{files})
3920@cindex input files in linker scripts
3921@cindex input object files in linker scripts
3922@cindex linker script input object files
3923The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
3924in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
3925
3926For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
3927a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
3928then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
3929
3930In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
3931script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
3932
e3f2db7f
AO
3933In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
3934with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
3935located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
16171946
FS
3936for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
3937@code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
3938filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
3939@samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3940
3941If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
3942the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
3943found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
3944not found the linker will search through the archive library search
3945path.
252b5132 3946
ff5dcc92 3947If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
a05a5b64 3948name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
252b5132
RH
3949@samp{-l}.
3950
3951When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
3952files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
3953script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
3954
3955@item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3956@itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3957@kindex GROUP(@var{files})
3958@cindex grouping input files
3959The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
3960files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
3961new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
a05a5b64 3962in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
252b5132 3963
b717d30e
JJ
3964@item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3965@itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3966@kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
3967This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
3968commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
3969as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
3970with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
3971when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
3972@option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
3973and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
3974setting afterwards.
3975
252b5132
RH
3976@item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
3977@kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
b45619c0 3978@cindex output file name in linker script
252b5132
RH
3979The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
3980@code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
3981@samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
a05a5b64 3982Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
252b5132
RH
3983precedence.
3984
3985You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
3986output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
3987
3988@item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3989@kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3990@cindex library search path in linker script
3991@cindex archive search path in linker script
3992@cindex search path in linker script
3993The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
ff5dcc92 3994@command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
252b5132 3995@code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
a05a5b64 3996on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
252b5132 3997are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
a05a5b64 3998the command-line option are searched first.
252b5132
RH
3999
4000@item STARTUP(@var{filename})
4001@kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
4002@cindex first input file
4003The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
4004that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
4005though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
4006when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
4007first file.
4008@end table
4009
4010@ifclear SingleFormat
4011@node Format Commands
36f63dca 4012@subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
252b5132
RH
4013A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
4014
4015@table @code
4016@item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4017@itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
4018@kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4019@cindex output file format in linker script
4020The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
4021output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
024531e2 4022exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 4023(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
252b5132
RH
4024line option takes precedence.
4025
4026You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
a05a5b64 4027formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
252b5132
RH
4028This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
4029desired endianness.
4030
4031If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
4032will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
4033output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
4034used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
4035
4036For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
4037command:
4038@smallexample
4039OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
4040@end smallexample
4041This says that the default format for the output file is
a05a5b64 4042@samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
252b5132
RH
4043option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
4044format.
4045
4046@item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4047@kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4048@cindex input file format in linker script
4049The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
4050files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
4051This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 4052(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
252b5132
RH
4053is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
4054command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
4055@end table
4056@end ifclear
4057
4a93e180
NC
4058@node REGION_ALIAS
4059@subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
4060@kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4061@cindex region alias
4062@cindex region names
4063
4064Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
4065@ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
4066
4067@smallexample
4068REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4069@end smallexample
4070
4071The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
4072memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
4073to memory regions. An example follows.
4074
4075Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
4076memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
4077that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
4078non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
4079access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
4080read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
4081sections:
4082
4083@itemize @bullet
4084@item
4085@code{.text} program code;
4086@item
4087@code{.rodata} read-only data;
4088@item
4089@code{.data} read-write initialized data;
4090@item
4091@code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
4092@end itemize
4093
4094The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
4095part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
4096output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
4097systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
4098@code{C}:
4099@multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
4100@item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
9d5777a3 4101@item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4a93e180
NC
4102@item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
4103@item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
4104@item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
4105@end multitable
4106The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
4107loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
4108the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4109the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4110
4111The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4112includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4113memory layout:
4114@smallexample
4115INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4116
4117SECTIONS
4118 @{
4119 .text :
4120 @{
4121 *(.text)
4122 @} > REGION_TEXT
4123 .rodata :
4124 @{
4125 *(.rodata)
4126 rodata_end = .;
4127 @} > REGION_RODATA
4128 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4129 @{
4130 data_start = .;
4131 *(.data)
4132 @} > REGION_DATA
4133 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4134 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4135 .bss :
4136 @{
4137 *(.bss)
4138 @} > REGION_BSS
4139 @}
4140@end smallexample
4141
4142Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4143regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4144variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4145@table @code
4146@item A
4147Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4148@smallexample
4149MEMORY
4150 @{
4151 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4152 @}
4153
4154REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4155REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4156REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4157REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4158@end smallexample
4159@item B
4160Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4161into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4162@code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4163@smallexample
4164MEMORY
4165 @{
4166 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4167 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4168 @}
4169
4170REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4171REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4172REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4173REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4174@end smallexample
4175@item C
4176Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4177@code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4178initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4179system start into the @code{RAM}.
4180@smallexample
4181MEMORY
4182 @{
4183 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4184 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4185 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4186 @}
4187
4188REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4189REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4190REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4191REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4192@end smallexample
4193@end table
4194
4195It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4196@code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4197necessary:
4198@smallexample
4199#include <string.h>
4200
4201extern char data_start [];
4202extern char data_size [];
4203extern char data_load_start [];
4204
4205void copy_data(void)
4206@{
4207 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4208 @{
4209 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4210 @}
4211@}
4212@end smallexample
4213
252b5132 4214@node Miscellaneous Commands
36f63dca 4215@subsection Other Linker Script Commands
252b5132
RH
4216There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4217
4218@table @code
4219@item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4220@kindex ASSERT
4221@cindex assertion in linker script
4222Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4223with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4224
fd1c4238
NC
4225Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4226take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4227inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4228for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4229symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4230
4231@smallexample
4232 .stack :
4233 @{
4234 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4235 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4236 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4237 @}
4238@end smallexample
4239
4240will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4241PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4242can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4243
4244@smallexample
4245 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4246 .stack :
4247 @{
4248 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4249 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4250 @}
4251@end smallexample
4252
4253will work.
4254
252b5132
RH
4255@item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4256@kindex EXTERN
4257@cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4258Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4259symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4260modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4261each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4262command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4263
4264@item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4265@kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4266@cindex common allocation in linker script
4267This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
ff5dcc92 4268to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
252b5132
RH
4269output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4270
4818e05f
AM
4271@item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4272@kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4273@cindex common allocation in linker script
4274This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4275command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4276to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4277
7bdf4127
AB
4278@item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4279@kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4280@cindex group allocation in linker script
4281@cindex section groups
4282@cindex COMDAT
4283This command has the same effect as the
4284@samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4285@command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4286and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4287specified (@samp{-r}).
4288
53d25da6
AM
4289@item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4290@kindex INSERT
4291@cindex insert user script into default script
4292This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4293augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4294inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4295@var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4296default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4297sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4298linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4299insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4300linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4301default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4302of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4303to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4304is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4305
4306@smallexample
4307SECTIONS
4308@{
4309 OVERLAY :
4310 @{
4311 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4312 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4313 @}
4314@}
4315INSERT AFTER .text;
4316@end smallexample
4317
252b5132
RH
4318@item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4319@kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4320@cindex cross references
ff5dcc92 4321This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
252b5132
RH
4322references among certain output sections.
4323
4324In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4325using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4326will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4327errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4328a function defined in the other section.
4329
4330The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
ff5dcc92 4331@command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
252b5132
RH
4332an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4333@code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4334names.
4335
cdf96953
MF
4336@item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4337@kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4338@cindex cross references
4339This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4340references to one section from a list of other sections.
4341
4342The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4343output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4344a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4345there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4346must never call back.
4347
4348The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4349The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4350If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4351the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4352status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4353names, not input section names.
4354
252b5132
RH
4355@ifclear SingleFormat
4356@item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4357@kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4358@cindex machine architecture
4359@cindex architecture
4360Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4361of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4362architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4363the @samp{-f} option.
4364@end ifclear
01554a74
AM
4365
4366@item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4367@kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4368This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4369@var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4370in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4371@xref{Expression Section}.
252b5132
RH
4372@end table
4373
4374@node Assignments
4375@section Assigning Values to Symbols
4376@cindex assignment in scripts
4377@cindex symbol definition, scripts
4378@cindex variables, defining
4379You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
73ae6183 4380the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
252b5132
RH
4381
4382@menu
4383* Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
eb8476a6 4384* HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
252b5132 4385* PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
7af8e998 4386* PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
73ae6183 4387* Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
252b5132
RH
4388@end menu
4389
4390@node Simple Assignments
4391@subsection Simple Assignments
4392
4393You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4394
4395@table @code
4396@item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4397@itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4398@itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4399@itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4400@itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4401@itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4402@itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4403@itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4404@itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4405@end table
4406
4407The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4408@var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4409defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4410
4411The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
b5666f2f 4412may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
252b5132
RH
4413
4414The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4415
4416Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4417
4418You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4419statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4420section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4421
4422The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4423expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4424
4425Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4426assignments may be used:
4427
4428@smallexample
4429floating_point = 0;
4430SECTIONS
4431@{
4432 .text :
4433 @{
4434 *(.text)
4435 _etext = .;
4436 @}
156e34dd 4437 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
252b5132
RH
4438 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4439@}
4440@end smallexample
4441@noindent
4442In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4443zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4444the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4445defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4446upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4447
eb8476a6
MR
4448@node HIDDEN
4449@subsection HIDDEN
4450@cindex HIDDEN
4451For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4452exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4453
4454Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4455@code{HIDDEN}:
4456
4457@smallexample
4458HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4459SECTIONS
4460@{
4461 .text :
4462 @{
4463 *(.text)
4464 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4465 @}
4466 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4467 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4468@}
4469@end smallexample
4470@noindent
4471In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4472
252b5132
RH
4473@node PROVIDE
4474@subsection PROVIDE
4475@cindex PROVIDE
4476In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4477only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4478the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4479@samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4480@samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4481@code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4482@samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4483@code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4484
4485Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4486@smallexample
4487SECTIONS
4488@{
4489 .text :
4490 @{
4491 *(.text)
4492 _etext = .;
4493 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4494 @}
4495@}
4496@end smallexample
4497
4498In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
3c27360b
JB
4499underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition diagnostic. If,
4500on the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
252b5132
RH
4501underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4502If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4503linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4504
b0daac83
NC
4505Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4506defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4507that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4508when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4509@samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4510
7af8e998
L
4511@node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4512@subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4513@cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4514Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4515hidden and won't be exported.
4516
73ae6183
NC
4517@node Source Code Reference
4518@subsection Source Code Reference
4519
4520Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4521intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4522a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4523symbol that does not have a value.
4524
4525Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4526transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4527stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4528prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4529mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4530of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4531variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4532linker script variable might be referred to as:
4533
4534@smallexample
4535 extern int foo;
4536@end smallexample
4537
4538But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4539
4540@smallexample
4541 _foo = 1000;
4542@end smallexample
4543
4544In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4545transformation has taken place.
4546
4547When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4548things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4549in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4550second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4551table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4552contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4553value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4554
4555@smallexample
4556 int foo = 1000;
4557@end smallexample
4558
10bf6894 4559creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
73ae6183
NC
4560holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4561number 1000 is initially stored.
4562
4563When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4564first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4565memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4566So:
4567
4568@smallexample
4569 foo = 1;
4570@end smallexample
4571
4572looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4573associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4574address. Whereas:
4575
4576@smallexample
4577 int * a = & foo;
4578@end smallexample
4579
10bf6894 4580looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
73ae6183
NC
4581and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4582the variable @samp{a}.
4583
4584Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4585the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4586an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4587
4588@smallexample
4589 foo = 1000;
4590@end smallexample
4591
4592creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4593the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4594address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4595linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4596access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4597
4598Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4599you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4600use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4601section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4602linker script contains these declarations:
4603
4604@smallexample
4605@group
4606 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
a5e406b5 4607 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
73ae6183
NC
4608 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4609@end group
4610@end smallexample
4611
4612Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4613
4614@smallexample
4615@group
4616 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
c0065db7 4617
73ae6183
NC
4618 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4619@end group
4620@end smallexample
4621
4622Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
5707d2ad
NC
4623Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4624arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4625
4626@smallexample
4627@group
4628 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4629
4630 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4631@end group
4632@end smallexample
4633
4634Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4635operators.
73ae6183 4636
252b5132 4637@node SECTIONS
36f63dca 4638@section SECTIONS Command
252b5132
RH
4639@kindex SECTIONS
4640The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4641into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4642
4643The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4644@smallexample
4645SECTIONS
4646@{
4647 @var{sections-command}
4648 @var{sections-command}
4649 @dots{}
4650@}
4651@end smallexample
4652
4653Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4654
4655@itemize @bullet
4656@item
4657an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4658@item
4659a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4660@item
4661an output section description
4662@item
4663an overlay description
4664@end itemize
4665
4666The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4667@code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4668those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4669understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4670the layout of the output file.
4671
4672Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4673below.
4674
4675If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4676linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4677section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4678input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4679example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4680in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4681
4682@menu
4683* Output Section Description:: Output section description
4684* Output Section Name:: Output section name
4685* Output Section Address:: Output section address
4686* Input Section:: Input section description
4687* Output Section Data:: Output section data
4688* Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4689* Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4690* Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4691* Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4692@end menu
4693
4694@node Output Section Description
36f63dca 4695@subsection Output Section Description
252b5132
RH
4696The full description of an output section looks like this:
4697@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 4698@group
7e7d5768 4699@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 4700 [AT(@var{lma})]
1eec346e 4701 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
4702 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4703 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
4704 @{
4705 @var{output-section-command}
4706 @var{output-section-command}
4707 @dots{}
abc9061b 4708 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
252b5132
RH
4709@end group
4710@end smallexample
4711
4712Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4713
4714The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4715name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
abc9061b
CC
4716The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4717the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
252b5132
RH
4718The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4719
4720Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4721
4722@itemize @bullet
4723@item
4724a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4725@item
4726an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4727@item
4728data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4729@item
4730a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4731@end itemize
4732
4733@node Output Section Name
36f63dca 4734@subsection Output Section Name
252b5132
RH
4735@cindex name, section
4736@cindex section name
4737The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4738meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4739support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4740must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4741example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4742output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4743names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4744quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4745characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4746commas must be quoted.
4747
4748The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4749Discarding}.
4750
4751@node Output Section Address
2a16d82a 4752@subsection Output Section Address
252b5132
RH
4753@cindex address, section
4754@cindex section address
4755The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
ea5cae92
NC
4756address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4757is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4758
4759If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4760section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4761to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4762alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4763contained within the output section.
4764
4765The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4766
4767@itemize @bullet
4768@item
4769If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4770is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4771in that region.
4772
4773@item
4774If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4775regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4776section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4777be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4778
4779@item
4780If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4781the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4782counter.
4783@end itemize
4784
4785@noindent
4786For example:
4787
252b5132
RH
4788@smallexample
4789.text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4790@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4791
252b5132
RH
4792@noindent
4793and
ea5cae92 4794
252b5132
RH
4795@smallexample
4796.text : @{ *(.text) @}
4797@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4798
252b5132
RH
4799@noindent
4800are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4801@samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4802counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
ea5cae92
NC
4803counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4804input sections.
252b5132
RH
4805
4806The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4807For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4808so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4809do something like this:
4810@smallexample
4811.text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4812@end smallexample
4813@noindent
4814This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4815aligned upward to the specified value.
4816
4817Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
6ce340f1
NC
4818location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4819sections are ignored).
252b5132
RH
4820
4821@node Input Section
36f63dca 4822@subsection Input Section Description
252b5132
RH
4823@cindex input sections
4824@cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4825The most common output section command is an input section description.
4826
4827The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4828You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4829in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4830map the input files into your memory layout.
4831
4832@menu
4833* Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4834* Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4835* Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4836* Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4837* Input Section Example:: Input section example
4838@end menu
4839
4840@node Input Section Basics
36f63dca 4841@subsubsection Input Section Basics
252b5132
RH
4842@cindex input section basics
4843An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4844by a list of section names in parentheses.
4845
4846The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4847describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4848
4849The most common input section description is to include all input
4850sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4851include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4852@smallexample
4853*(.text)
4854@end smallexample
4855@noindent
18625d54 4856Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
8f1732fc 4857@cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
18625d54
CM
4858of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4859match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4860example:
252b5132 4861@smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4862EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4863@end smallexample
4864@noindent
4865will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4866and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4867placed inside the section list, for example:
4868@smallexample
b4346c09 4869*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
252b5132 4870@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4871@noindent
4872The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
4873two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4874more than one section, as described below.
252b5132
RH
4875
4876There are two ways to include more than one section:
4877@smallexample
4878*(.text .rdata)
4879*(.text) *(.rdata)
4880@end smallexample
4881@noindent
4882The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4883@samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
b6bf44ba
AM
4884first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4885they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
252b5132
RH
4886@samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4887@samp{.rdata} input sections.
4888
8f1732fc
AB
4889When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4890is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4891immediately following section, for example:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4892@smallexample
4893*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4894@end smallexample
4895@noindent
4896will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4897@file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4898from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
4899exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
8f1732fc 4900could be modified to:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4901@smallexample
4902*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
4903@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4904@noindent
4905Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
4906before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
4907all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
4908@smallexample
4909EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
4910@end smallexample
a5bf7d4f 4911
252b5132
RH
4912You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
4913You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
4914needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
4915@smallexample
4916data.o(.data)
4917@end smallexample
4918
ae17ab41
CM
4919To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
4920of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
4921
4922Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
4923
4924@smallexample
4925@group
4926SECTIONS @{
4927 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
4928 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
4929@}
4930@end group
4931@end smallexample
4932
4933In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
4934input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
4935@code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
4936@samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
4937whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
4938
967928e9
AM
4939You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
4940matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
4941with no whitespace around the colon.
4942
4943@table @samp
4944@item archive:file
4945matches file within archive
4946@item archive:
4947matches the whole archive
4948@item :file
4949matches file but not one in an archive
4950@end table
4951
4952Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
4953wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
4954single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
4955@samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
4956within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
4957also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
4958other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
4959from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
4960command.
4961
252b5132
RH
4962If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
4963the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
4964commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
4965@smallexample
4966data.o
4967@end smallexample
4968
967928e9
AM
4969When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
4970and does not contain any wild card
252b5132
RH
4971characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
4972name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
4973did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
4974though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
4975@code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
4976the archive search path.
4977
4978@node Input Section Wildcards
36f63dca 4979@subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
252b5132
RH
4980@cindex input section wildcards
4981@cindex wildcard file name patterns
4982@cindex file name wildcard patterns
4983@cindex section name wildcard patterns
4984In an input section description, either the file name or the section
4985name or both may be wildcard patterns.
4986
4987The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
4988pattern for the file name.
4989
4990The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
4991
4992@table @samp
4993@item *
4994matches any number of characters
4995@item ?
4996matches any single character
4997@item [@var{chars}]
4998matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
4999character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
5000@samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
5001@item \
5002quotes the following character
5003@end table
5004
5005When a file name is matched with a wildcard, the wildcard characters
5006will not match a @samp{/} character (used to separate directory names on
5007Unix). A pattern consisting of a single @samp{*} character is an
5008exception; it will always match any file name, whether it contains a
5009@samp{/} or not. In a section name, the wildcard characters will match
5010a @samp{/} character.
5011
5012File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
5013specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
5014does not search directories to expand wildcards.
5015
5016If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
5017appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
5018will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
5019sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
5020@file{data.o} rule will not be used:
5021@smallexample
5022.data : @{ *(.data) @}
5023.data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
5024@end smallexample
5025
bcaa7b3e 5026@cindex SORT_BY_NAME
252b5132
RH
5027Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
5028in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
bcaa7b3e
L
5029this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
5030pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
5031@code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
252b5132
RH
5032into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
5033
bcaa7b3e 5034@cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
9a24a276
AM
5035@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5036@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
5037alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
5038alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
5039needed.
bcaa7b3e 5040
02ecc8e9 5041@cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
9a24a276
AM
5042@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5043@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
5044numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
5045section name before placing them in the output file. In
5046@code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
5047the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
5048@code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
02ecc8e9 5049
bcaa7b3e
L
5050@cindex SORT
5051@code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5052
5053When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
5054can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
5055
5056@enumerate
5057@item
5058@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5059It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5060sections have the same name.
5061@item
5062@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5063It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5064sections have the same alignment.
5065@item
c0065db7 5066@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
bcaa7b3e
L
5067treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
5068@item
5069@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
5070is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
5071@item
5072All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
5073@end enumerate
5074
a05a5b64 5075When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
bcaa7b3e 5076section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
a05a5b64 5077takes precedence over the command-line option.
bcaa7b3e
L
5078
5079If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
a05a5b64 5080command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
bcaa7b3e
L
5081treated as nested sorting command.
5082
5083@enumerate
5084@item
5085@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
5086@option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
5087@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5088@item
5089@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
5090@option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
5091@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5092@end enumerate
5093
5094If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
a05a5b64 5095command-line option will be ignored.
bcaa7b3e 5096
eda680f8 5097@cindex SORT_NONE
a05a5b64 5098@code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
eda680f8
L
5099section sorting option.
5100
252b5132
RH
5101If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
5102@samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
5103precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
5104
5105This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
5106files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
5107sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5108The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5109with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5110linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5111@smallexample
5112@group
5113SECTIONS @{
5114 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5115 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5116 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5117 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5118@}
5119@end group
5120@end smallexample
5121
5122@node Input Section Common
36f63dca 5123@subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
252b5132
RH
5124@cindex common symbol placement
5125@cindex uninitialized data placement
5126A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5127file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5128linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5129named @samp{COMMON}.
5130
5131You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5132other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5133particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5134input files are placed in another section.
5135
5136In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5137@samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5138@smallexample
5139.bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5140@end smallexample
5141
5142@cindex scommon section
5143@cindex small common symbols
5144Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5145example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5146symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5147different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5148the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5149symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5150to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5151locations.
5152
5153@cindex [COMMON]
5154You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5155notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5156@samp{*(COMMON)}.
5157
5158@node Input Section Keep
36f63dca 5159@subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
252b5132
RH
5160@cindex KEEP
5161@cindex garbage collection
5162When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
a1ab1d2a 5163it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
252b5132
RH
5164This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5165with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
bcaa7b3e 5166@code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
252b5132
RH
5167
5168@node Input Section Example
36f63dca 5169@subsubsection Input Section Example
252b5132
RH
5170The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5171to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5172start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5173@samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5174follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5175@samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5176@samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5177All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5178files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5179
5180@smallexample
5181@group
5182SECTIONS @{
5183 outputa 0x10000 :
5184 @{
5185 all.o
5186 foo.o (.input1)
5187 @}
36f63dca
NC
5188@end group
5189@group
252b5132
RH
5190 outputb :
5191 @{
5192 foo.o (.input2)
5193 foo1.o (.input1)
5194 @}
36f63dca
NC
5195@end group
5196@group
252b5132
RH
5197 outputc :
5198 @{
5199 *(.input1)
5200 *(.input2)
5201 @}
5202@}
5203@end group
a1ab1d2a 5204@end smallexample
252b5132 5205
cbd0eecf
L
5206If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5207and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5208automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5209__stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5210indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5211respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5212C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5213
252b5132 5214@node Output Section Data
36f63dca 5215@subsection Output Section Data
252b5132
RH
5216@cindex data
5217@cindex section data
5218@cindex output section data
5219@kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5220@kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5221@kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5222@kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5223@kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5224You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5225@code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5226an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5227parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5228value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5229counter.
5230
5231The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5232store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5233bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5234stored.
5235
5236For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5237of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5238@smallexample
5239BYTE(1)
5240LONG(addr)
5241@end smallexample
5242
5243When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5244same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5245target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5246@code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5247@code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5248
5249If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5250which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5251When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5252true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5253endianness of the first input object file.
5254
36f63dca 5255Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
2b5fc1f5
NC
5256between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5257@smallexample
5258SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5259@end smallexample
5260whereas this will work:
5261@smallexample
5262SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5263@end smallexample
5264
252b5132
RH
5265@kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5266@cindex holes, filling
5267@cindex unspecified memory
5268You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5269current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5270otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5271gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
a139d329 5272with the value of the expression, repeated as
252b5132
RH
5273necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5274point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5275than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5276different parts of an output section.
5277
5278This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
563e308f 5279value @samp{0x90}:
252b5132 5280@smallexample
563e308f 5281FILL(0x90909090)
252b5132
RH
5282@end smallexample
5283
5284The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
9673c93c 5285section attribute, but it only affects the
252b5132
RH
5286part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5287entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
9673c93c 5288precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
a139d329 5289expression.
252b5132
RH
5290
5291@node Output Section Keywords
36f63dca 5292@subsection Output Section Keywords
252b5132
RH
5293There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5294commands.
5295
5296@table @code
5297@kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5298@cindex input filename symbols
5299@cindex filename symbols
5300@item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5301The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5302The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5303file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5304the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5305
5306This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5307normally used for any other object file format.
5308
5309@kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5310@cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5311@cindex constructors, arranging in link
5312@item CONSTRUCTORS
5313When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5314unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5315destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5316arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5317automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5318For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5319linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5320@code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5321ignored for other object file formats.
5322
5323The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
7e69709c
AM
5324constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5325Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5326the start and end of the global destructors. The
252b5132
RH
5327first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5328of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5329compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5330formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5331@code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5332the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5333destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5334@code{exit}.
5335
5336For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5337arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5338addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5339and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5340linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5341runtime code expects to see.
5342
5343@smallexample
5344 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5345 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5346 *(.ctors)
5347 LONG(0)
5348 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5349 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5350 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5351 *(.dtors)
5352 LONG(0)
5353 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5354@end smallexample
5355
5356If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5357which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5358are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5359are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
bcaa7b3e
L
5360command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5361@code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5362@samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
252b5132
RH
5363@samp{*(.dtors)}.
5364
5365Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5366and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5367need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5368scripts.
5369
5370@end table
5371
5372@node Output Section Discarding
36f63dca 5373@subsection Output Section Discarding
252b5132
RH
5374@cindex discarding sections
5375@cindex sections, discarding
5376@cindex removing sections
2edab91c
AM
5377The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5378This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5379may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
252b5132 5380@smallexample
49c13adb 5381.foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
252b5132
RH
5382@end smallexample
5383@noindent
5384will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
74541ad4
AM
5385@samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5386sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
2edab91c
AM
5387space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5388too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5389space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5390@samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5391@samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5392This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
74541ad4 5393
a0976ea4 5394The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
74541ad4
AM
5395on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5396symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
a0976ea4
AM
5397the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5398section is discarded.
252b5132
RH
5399
5400@cindex /DISCARD/
5401The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5402input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5403section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5404
99fabbc9
JL
5405This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5406@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5407garbage collection.
5408
a2e098c3
NC
5409Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5410discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5411members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5412Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5413
252b5132 5414@node Output Section Attributes
36f63dca 5415@subsection Output Section Attributes
252b5132
RH
5416@cindex output section attributes
5417We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5418like this:
0c71d759 5419
252b5132 5420@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 5421@group
7e7d5768 5422@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 5423 [AT(@var{lma})]
3bbec4bd 5424 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
5425 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5426 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
5427 @{
5428 @var{output-section-command}
5429 @var{output-section-command}
5430 @dots{}
562d3460 5431 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
252b5132
RH
5432@end group
5433@end smallexample
0c71d759 5434
252b5132
RH
5435We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5436@var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5437remaining section attributes.
5438
a1ab1d2a 5439@menu
252b5132
RH
5440* Output Section Type:: Output section type
5441* Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
bbf115d3 5442* Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
7e7d5768 5443* Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
0c71d759 5444* Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
252b5132
RH
5445* Output Section Region:: Output section region
5446* Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5447* Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5448@end menu
5449
5450@node Output Section Type
36f63dca 5451@subsubsection Output Section Type
252b5132
RH
5452Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5453parentheses. The following types are defined:
5454
5455@table @code
5456@item NOLOAD
5457The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5458loaded into memory when the program is run.
5459@item DSECT
5460@itemx COPY
5461@itemx INFO
5462@itemx OVERLAY
5463These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5464rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5465marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5466section when the program is run.
5467@end table
5468
5469@kindex NOLOAD
5470@cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5471@cindex loading, preventing
5472The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5473the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5474the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5475@samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
2e76e85a 5476need to be loaded when the program is run.
252b5132
RH
5477@smallexample
5478@group
5479SECTIONS @{
5480 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5481 @dots{}
5482@}
5483@end group
5484@end smallexample
5485
5486@node Output Section LMA
36f63dca 5487@subsubsection Output Section LMA
562d3460 5488@kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
252b5132
RH
5489@kindex AT(@var{lma})
5490@cindex load address
5491@cindex section load address
5492Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
ea5cae92
NC
5493@ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5494@pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5495specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5496address is optional.
6bdafbeb 5497
ea5cae92
NC
5498The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5499specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5500takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5501load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5502region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
dc0b6aa0
AM
5503
5504If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
ea5cae92
NC
5505section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5506load address:
5507
5508@itemize @bullet
5509@item
5510If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5511the LMA address as well.
5512
5513@item
5514If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5515
5516@item
5517Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5518with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5519section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5520VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5521the last section in the located region.
5522
5523@item
5524If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5525that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5526
5527@item
5528If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5529section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5530@end itemize
252b5132
RH
5531
5532@cindex ROM initialized data
5533@cindex initialized data in ROM
5534This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5535example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5536called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5537@samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5538even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5539uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5540defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5541counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5542
5543@smallexample
5544@group
5545SECTIONS
5546 @{
5547 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
a1ab1d2a 5548 .mdata 0x2000 :
252b5132
RH
5549 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5550 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5551 .bss 0x3000 :
5552 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5553@}
5554@end group
5555@end smallexample
5556
5557The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5558this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5559the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5560how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5561script.
5562
5563@smallexample
5564@group
5565extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5566char *src = &_etext;
5567char *dst = &_data;
5568
ea5cae92
NC
5569/* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5570while (dst < &_edata)
252b5132 5571 *dst++ = *src++;
252b5132 5572
ea5cae92 5573/* Zero bss. */
252b5132
RH
5574for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5575 *dst = 0;
5576@end group
5577@end smallexample
5578
bbf115d3
L
5579@node Forced Output Alignment
5580@subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5581@kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5582@cindex forcing output section alignment
5583@cindex output section alignment
1eec346e 5584You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
13075d04
SH
5585alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5586intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
bbf115d3 5587
7e7d5768
AM
5588@node Forced Input Alignment
5589@subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5590@kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5591@cindex forcing input section alignment
5592@cindex input section alignment
5593You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5594SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5595sections, whether larger or smaller.
5596
0c71d759
NC
5597@node Output Section Constraint
5598@subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5599@kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5600@kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5601@cindex constraints on output sections
5602You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5603of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5604read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5605@code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5606
252b5132 5607@node Output Section Region
36f63dca 5608@subsubsection Output Section Region
252b5132
RH
5609@kindex >@var{region}
5610@cindex section, assigning to memory region
5611@cindex memory regions and sections
5612You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5613using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5614
5615Here is a simple example:
5616@smallexample
5617@group
5618MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5619SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5620@end group
5621@end smallexample
5622
5623@node Output Section Phdr
36f63dca 5624@subsubsection Output Section Phdr
252b5132
RH
5625@kindex :@var{phdr}
5626@cindex section, assigning to program header
5627@cindex program headers and sections
5628You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5629using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5630one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5631assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5632@code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5633linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5634
5635Here is a simple example:
5636@smallexample
5637@group
5638PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5639SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5640@end group
5641@end smallexample
5642
5643@node Output Section Fill
36f63dca 5644@subsubsection Output Section Fill
252b5132
RH
5645@kindex =@var{fillexp}
5646@cindex section fill pattern
5647@cindex fill pattern, entire section
5648You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5649@samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5650(@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5651within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
a139d329
AM
5652alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5653necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
9673c93c 5654of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
a139d329
AM
5655an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5656fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
9673c93c 5657other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
a139d329
AM
5658pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5659expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
252b5132
RH
5660
5661You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
9673c93c 5662output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
252b5132
RH
5663
5664Here is a simple example:
5665@smallexample
5666@group
563e308f 5667SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
252b5132
RH
5668@end group
5669@end smallexample
5670
5671@node Overlay Description
36f63dca 5672@subsection Overlay Description
252b5132
RH
5673@kindex OVERLAY
5674@cindex overlays
5675An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5676are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5677the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5678copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5679required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5680can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5681than another.
5682
5683Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5684@code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5685output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5686command is as follows:
5687@smallexample
5688@group
5689OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5690 @{
5691 @var{secname1}
5692 @{
5693 @var{output-section-command}
5694 @var{output-section-command}
5695 @dots{}
5696 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5697 @var{secname2}
5698 @{
5699 @var{output-section-command}
5700 @var{output-section-command}
5701 @dots{}
5702 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5703 @dots{}
abc9061b 5704 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
252b5132
RH
5705@end group
5706@end smallexample
5707
5708Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5709section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5710section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
11e7fd74 5711those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
252b5132
RH
5712except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5713sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5714
abc9061b
CC
5715The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5716the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5717
252b5132
RH
5718The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5719addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5720memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5721whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5722and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5723and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5724
56dd11f0
NC
5725If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5726references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5727the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5728sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5729@xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
252b5132
RH
5730
5731For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
34711ca3 5732provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
252b5132
RH
5733defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5734@code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5735the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5736within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5737symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5738
5739At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5740the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5741
5742Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5743@code{SECTIONS} construct.
5744@smallexample
5745@group
5746 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5747 @{
5748 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5749 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5750 @}
5751@end group
5752@end smallexample
5753@noindent
5754This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5755address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5756@samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
34711ca3 5757following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
252b5132
RH
5758@code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5759@code{__load_stop_text1}.
5760
5761C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5762like the following.
5763
5764@smallexample
5765@group
5766 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5767 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5768 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5769@end group
5770@end smallexample
5771
5772Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5773everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5774example could have been written identically as follows.
5775
5776@smallexample
5777@group
5778 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5779 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5780 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
252b5132 5781 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5782 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5783 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
252b5132
RH
5784 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5785@end group
5786@end smallexample
5787
5788@node MEMORY
36f63dca 5789@section MEMORY Command
252b5132
RH
5790@kindex MEMORY
5791@cindex memory regions
5792@cindex regions of memory
5793@cindex allocating memory
5794@cindex discontinuous memory
5795The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5796memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5797
5798The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5799memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5800may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5801can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5802set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5803regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5804around to fit into the available regions.
5805
127fcdff
AB
5806A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5807however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5808specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5809@code{MEMORY} is:
252b5132
RH
5810@smallexample
5811@group
a1ab1d2a 5812MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5813 @{
5814 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5815 @dots{}
5816 @}
5817@end group
5818@end smallexample
5819
5820The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5821region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5822Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5823with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
4a93e180
NC
5824must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
5825add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
9d5777a3 5826command.
252b5132
RH
5827
5828@cindex memory region attributes
5829The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5830whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5831not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
5832@ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5833section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5834the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5835them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5836
5837The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5838@table @samp
5839@item R
5840Read-only section
5841@item W
5842Read/write section
5843@item X
5844Executable section
5845@item A
5846Allocatable section
5847@item I
5848Initialized section
5849@item L
5850Same as @samp{I}
5851@item !
c09e9a8c 5852Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
252b5132
RH
5853@end table
5854
81c688d5 5855If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
252b5132 5856@samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
81c688d5
NC
5857attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5858unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
5859not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
5860string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
5861or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
5862the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
252b5132
RH
5863
5864@kindex ORIGIN =
5865@kindex o =
5866@kindex org =
9cd6d51a
NC
5867The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
5868the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
5869cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
5870abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
5871@code{ORG}).
252b5132
RH
5872
5873@kindex LENGTH =
5874@kindex len =
5875@kindex l =
5876The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
5877region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
9cd6d51a
NC
5878be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
5879@code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
252b5132
RH
5880
5881In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
5882available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
5883and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
5884linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
5885is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
5886or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
5887explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
5888region.
5889
5890@smallexample
5891@group
a1ab1d2a 5892MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5893 @{
5894 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
5895 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
5896 @}
5897@end group
5898@end smallexample
5899
5900Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
5901specific output sections into that memory region by using the
5902@samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
5903a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
5904output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
5905was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
5906the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
5907output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
5908region, the linker will issue an error message.
5909
3ec57632 5910It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
c0065db7 5911expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
3ec57632
NC
5912@code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
5913
5914@smallexample
5915@group
c0065db7 5916 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
3ec57632
NC
5917@end group
5918@end smallexample
5919
252b5132
RH
5920@node PHDRS
5921@section PHDRS Command
5922@kindex PHDRS
5923@cindex program headers
5924@cindex ELF program headers
5925@cindex program segments
5926@cindex segments, ELF
5927The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
5928@dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
5929loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
5930program with the @samp{-p} option.
5931
5932When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
5933reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
5934program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
5935This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
5936interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
5937
5938The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
5939in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
5940precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
5941the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
5942not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
5943
5944The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
5945generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
5946ignore @code{PHDRS}.
5947
5948This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
5949@code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
5950
5951@smallexample
5952@group
5953PHDRS
5954@{
5955 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
5956 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
5957@}
5958@end group
5959@end smallexample
5960
5961The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
5962of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
5963header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5964with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5c1a3f0f
NS
5965must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
5966is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
252b5132
RH
5967
5968Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
5969system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
5970specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
5971sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
5972attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
5973Section Phdr}.
5974
5975It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
5976merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
5977repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
5978contain the section.
5979
5980If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
5981then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
5982not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
5983convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
5984placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
5985default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
5986segment at all.
5987
5988@kindex FILEHDR
5989@kindex PHDRS
5c1a3f0f 5990You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
252b5132
RH
5991the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
5992The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
5993file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
5c1a3f0f 5994include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
4100cea3
AM
5995segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
5996these keywords.
252b5132
RH
5997
5998The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
5999value of the keyword.
6000
6001@table @asis
6002@item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
6003Indicates an unused program header.
6004
6005@item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
6006Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
6007the file.
6008
6009@item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
6010Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
6011
6012@item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
6013Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
6014found.
6015
6016@item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
6017Indicates a segment holding note information.
6018
6019@item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
6020A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
6021ABI.
6022
6023@item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
6024Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
6025
1a9ccd70
NC
6026@item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
6027Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
6028
252b5132
RH
6029@item @var{expression}
6030An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
6031be used for types not defined above.
6032@end table
6033
6034You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
6035in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
6036@code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
6037Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
6038output section attribute.
6039
6040The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
6041which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
6042explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
6043an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
6044header.
6045
6046Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
6047headers used on a native ELF system.
6048
6049@example
6050@group
6051PHDRS
6052@{
6053 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
6054 interp PT_INTERP ;
6055 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
6056 data PT_LOAD ;
6057 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
6058@}
6059
6060SECTIONS
6061@{
6062 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
6063 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
6064 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
6065 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
6066 @dots{}
6067 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
6068 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
6069 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
6070 @dots{}
6071@}
6072@end group
6073@end example
6074
6075@node VERSION
6076@section VERSION Command
6077@kindex VERSION @{script text@}
6078@cindex symbol versions
6079@cindex version script
6080@cindex versions of symbols
6081The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
6082only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
6083symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
6084a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
6085shared library.
6086
6087You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
6088you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
6089also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
6090
6091The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
6092@smallexample
6093VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
6094@end smallexample
6095
6096The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
6097Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
6098version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
6099version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
6100version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
6101scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
6102library.
6103
6104The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
6105examples.
6106
6107@smallexample
6108VERS_1.1 @{
6109 global:
6110 foo1;
6111 local:
a1ab1d2a
UD
6112 old*;
6113 original*;
6114 new*;
252b5132
RH
6115@};
6116
6117VERS_1.2 @{
6118 foo2;
6119@} VERS_1.1;
6120
6121VERS_2.0 @{
6122 bar1; bar2;
c0065db7 6123 extern "C++" @{
86043bbb 6124 ns::*;
bb1515f2
MF
6125 "f(int, double)";
6126 @};
252b5132
RH
6127@} VERS_1.2;
6128@end smallexample
6129
6130This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6131version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6132The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6133a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
313e35ee
AM
6134of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6135symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6136is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6137in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
86043bbb
MM
6138However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6139name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
252b5132
RH
6140
6141Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6142depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6143to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6144
6145Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6146depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6147and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6148
6149When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6150specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6151unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
a981ed6f 6152unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
ae5a3597
AM
6153somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6154wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6155wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6156set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6157ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
252b5132
RH
6158
6159The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6160they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6161could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6162However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6163
0f6bf451 6164Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6b9b879a
JJ
6165in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6166symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6167won't.
6168
6169@smallexample
7c9c73be 6170@{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
9d201f2f 6171@end smallexample
6b9b879a 6172
252b5132
RH
6173When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6174symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6175requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6176shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6177loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6178linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6179application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6180way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6181all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6182search for each symbol reference.
6183
6184The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6185doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6186that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6187functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6188the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6189required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6190that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6191versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6192the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6193
6194There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6195first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6196source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6197script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6198maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6199@smallexample
6200__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6201@end smallexample
6202@noindent
6203in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6204be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6205The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
96a94295
L
6206@samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6207takes precedence over a version script.
252b5132
RH
6208
6209The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6210function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6211an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6212version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6213linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6214
6215To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6216source file. Here is an example:
6217
6218@smallexample
6219__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6220__asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6221__asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6222__asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6223@end smallexample
6224
6225In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6226unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6227example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6228@samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6229
6230When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6231some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6232this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6233@samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6234declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6235you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6236
6237If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6238within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
36f63dca 6239(i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
252b5132
RH
6240specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6241
cb840a31
L
6242You can also specify the language in the version script:
6243
6244@smallexample
6245VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6246@end smallexample
6247
c0065db7 6248The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
cb840a31
L
6249The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6250demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
bb1515f2
MF
6251patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6252@samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
cb840a31 6253
86043bbb
MM
6254Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6255described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6256or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6257the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6258whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6259cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6260might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6261should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6262expect when you upgrade.
6263
252b5132
RH
6264@node Expressions
6265@section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6266@cindex expressions
6267@cindex arithmetic
6268The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
6269that of C expressions. All expressions are evaluated as integers. All
6270expressions are evaluated in the same size, which is 32 bits if both the
6271host and target are 32 bits, and is otherwise 64 bits.
6272
6273You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6274
6275The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6276expressions.
6277
6278@menu
6279* Constants:: Constants
0c71d759 6280* Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
252b5132 6281* Symbols:: Symbol Names
ecca9871 6282* Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
252b5132
RH
6283* Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6284* Operators:: Operators
6285* Evaluation:: Evaluation
6286* Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6287* Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6288@end menu
6289
6290@node Constants
6291@subsection Constants
6292@cindex integer notation
6293@cindex constants in linker scripts
6294All constants are integers.
6295
6296As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6297octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
8a308ae8 6298hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
11e7fd74 6299@samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
8a308ae8
NC
6300@samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6301value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
252b5132
RH
6302
6303@cindex scaled integers
6304@cindex K and M integer suffixes
6305@cindex M and K integer suffixes
6306@cindex suffixes for integers
6307@cindex integer suffixes
6308In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6309constant by
6310@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6311@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6312@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6313@code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6314@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6315@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6316@tex
6317${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6318@end tex
6319@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
8a308ae8
NC
6320respectively. For example, the following
6321all refer to the same quantity:
6322
252b5132 6323@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6324_fourk_1 = 4K;
6325_fourk_2 = 4096;
6326_fourk_3 = 0x1000;
8a308ae8 6327_fourk_4 = 10000o;
252b5132
RH
6328@end smallexample
6329
8a308ae8
NC
6330Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6331conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6332
0c71d759
NC
6333@node Symbolic Constants
6334@subsection Symbolic Constants
6335@cindex symbolic constants
6336@kindex CONSTANT
a094d01f 6337It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
0c71d759
NC
6338the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6339
6340@table @code
6341@item MAXPAGESIZE
6342@kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6343The target's maximum page size.
6344
6345@item COMMONPAGESIZE
6346@kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6347The target's default page size.
6348@end table
6349
6350So for example:
6351
6352@smallexample
9d5777a3 6353 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
0c71d759
NC
6354@end smallexample
6355
6356will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6357supported by the target.
6358
252b5132
RH
6359@node Symbols
6360@subsection Symbol Names
6361@cindex symbol names
6362@cindex names
6363@cindex quoted symbol names
6364@kindex "
6365Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6366and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6367Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6368specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6369keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6370@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6371"SECTION" = 9;
6372"with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
252b5132
RH
6373@end smallexample
6374
6375Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6376to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6377whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6378
ecca9871
L
6379@node Orphan Sections
6380@subsection Orphan Sections
6381@cindex orphan
6382Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6383are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6384script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
a87ded7b
AB
6385output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6386in which to place the orphaned input section.
6387
6388If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6389an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6390placed at the end of that output section.
6391
6392If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6393sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6394name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6395orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6396one new output section.
6397
6398If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6399then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
e299b355
AM
6400in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6401linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6402attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6403sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6404support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
ecca9871 6405
a05a5b64
TP
6406The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6407(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
c005eb9e
AB
6408output sections an orphan is placed in.
6409
252b5132
RH
6410@node Location Counter
6411@subsection The Location Counter
6412@kindex .
6413@cindex dot
6414@cindex location counter
6415@cindex current output location
6416The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6417current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6418location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6419within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6420anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6421
6422@cindex holes
6423Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6424moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
dc0b6aa0
AM
6425location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6426and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6427doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
252b5132
RH
6428
6429@smallexample
6430SECTIONS
6431@{
6432 output :
6433 @{
6434 file1(.text)
6435 . = . + 1000;
6436 file2(.text)
6437 . += 1000;
6438 file3(.text)
563e308f 6439 @} = 0x12345678;
252b5132
RH
6440@}
6441@end smallexample
6442@noindent
6443In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6444located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6445followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6446@file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
563e308f 6447@samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
252b5132
RH
6448specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6449
5c6bbab8
NC
6450@cindex dot inside sections
6451Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6452current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
69da35b5 6453statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
5c6bbab8
NC
6454absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6455however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6456not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6457
6458@smallexample
6459SECTIONS
6460@{
6461 . = 0x100
6462 .text: @{
6463 *(.text)
6464 . = 0x200
6465 @}
6466 . = 0x500
6467 .data: @{
6468 *(.data)
6469 . += 0x600
6470 @}
6471@}
6472@end smallexample
6473
6474The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6475and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6476the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6477much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6478move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6479and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6480the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6481the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6482
b5666f2f
AM
6483@cindex dot outside sections
6484Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6485output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6486needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6487
6488@smallexample
6489SECTIONS
6490@{
6491 start_of_text = . ;
6492 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6493 end_of_text = . ;
6494
6495 start_of_data = . ;
6496 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6497 end_of_data = . ;
6498@}
6499@end smallexample
6500
6501If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6502not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6503between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6504should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6505blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6506the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6507sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6508statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6509special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6510place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6511as follows:
6512
6513@smallexample
6514SECTIONS
6515@{
6516 start_of_text = . ;
6517 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6518 end_of_text = . ;
6519
6520 start_of_data = . ;
6521 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6522 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6523 end_of_data = . ;
6524@}
6525@end smallexample
6526
6527This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6528@code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6529placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6530assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6531a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6532section. So you could write:
6533
6534@smallexample
6535SECTIONS
6536@{
6537 start_of_text = . ;
6538 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6539 end_of_text = . ;
6540
6541 . = . ;
6542 start_of_data = . ;
6543 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6544 end_of_data = . ;
6545@}
6546@end smallexample
6547
6548Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6549@code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6550
252b5132
RH
6551@need 2000
6552@node Operators
6553@subsection Operators
6554@cindex operators for arithmetic
6555@cindex arithmetic operators
6556@cindex precedence in expressions
6557The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6558the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6559@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6560@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6561@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6562@smallexample
6563precedence associativity Operators Notes
6564(highest)
65651 left ! - ~ (1)
65662 left * / %
65673 left + -
65684 left >> <<
65695 left == != > < <= >=
65706 left &
65717 left |
65728 left &&
65739 left ||
657410 right ? :
657511 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6576(lowest)
6577@end smallexample
6578Notes:
a1ab1d2a 6579(1) Prefix operators
252b5132
RH
6580(2) @xref{Assignments}.
6581@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6582@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6583@tex
6584\vskip \baselineskip
6585%"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6586\hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6587\hrule
6588\halign
6589{\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6590height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6591&Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6592height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6593\noalign{\hrule}
6594height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6595&highest&&&&&\cr
6596% '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
a1ab1d2a 6597&1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
252b5132
RH
6598&2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6599&3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6600&4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6601&5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6602&6&&left&&\&&\cr
6603&7&&left&&|&\cr
6604&8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6605&9&&left&&||&\cr
6606&10&&right&&? :&\cr
6607&11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6608&lowest&&&&&\cr
6609height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6610\hrule}
6611@end tex
6612@iftex
6613{
6614@obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6615@dag@quad Prefix operators.
6616@ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6617}
6618@end iftex
6619@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6620
6621@node Evaluation
6622@subsection Evaluation
6623@cindex lazy evaluation
6624@cindex expression evaluation order
6625The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6626an expression when absolutely necessary.
6627
6628The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6629address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6630regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6631as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6632
6633However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6634until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6635other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6636for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6637
6638The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6639assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6640allocation.
6641
6642Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6643@samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6644
6645If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6646available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6647following
6648@smallexample
6649@group
6650SECTIONS
6651 @{
a1ab1d2a 6652 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
252b5132
RH
6653 @{ *(.text) @}
6654 @}
6655@end group
6656@end smallexample
6657@noindent
6658will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6659address}.
6660
6661@node Expression Section
6662@subsection The Section of an Expression
6663@cindex expression sections
6664@cindex absolute expressions
6665@cindex relative expressions
6666@cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6667@cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6668@cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
7542af2a
AM
6669Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6670relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6671using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6672value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6673symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6674operations.
6675
abf4be64
AM
6676Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6677section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6678address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6679@code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6680functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
01554a74
AM
6681One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6682(@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
5c3049d2
AM
6683differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6684versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6685section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6686Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
01554a74
AM
6687absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6688given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6689everywhere.
5c3049d2
AM
6690
6691In the following simple example,
252b5132 6692
7542af2a
AM
6693@smallexample
6694@group
6695SECTIONS
6696 @{
6697 . = 0x100;
6698 __executable_start = 0x100;
6699 .data :
6700 @{
6701 . = 0x10;
6702 __data_start = 0x10;
6703 *(.data)
6704 @}
6705 @dots{}
6706 @}
6707@end group
6708@end smallexample
252b5132 6709
7542af2a
AM
6710both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6711address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6712@code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6713section in the second two assignments.
252b5132 6714
5c3049d2
AM
6715For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6716addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
7542af2a
AM
6717
6718@itemize @bullet
6719@item
c05f749e
AM
6720Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6721operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6722absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6723@item
7542af2a
AM
6724Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6725relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6726and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6727@item
c05f749e
AM
6728Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6729in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6730address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6731before applying the operator.
7542af2a
AM
6732@end itemize
6733
6734The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6735
6736@itemize @bullet
6737@item
6738An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6739@item
6740The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6741@item
9bc8bb33 6742The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
11e7fd74 6743relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
94b41882
AM
6744(after above conversions) is also a number when
6745@code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6746but an absolute address otherwise.
9bc8bb33
AM
6747@item
6748The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6749relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6750section as the relative operand(s).
7542af2a
AM
6751@item
6752The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6753conversions) is an absolute address.
6754@end itemize
252b5132
RH
6755
6756You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6757to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6758create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6759section @samp{.data}:
6760@smallexample
6761SECTIONS
6762 @{
6763 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6764 @}
6765@end smallexample
6766@noindent
6767If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6768@samp{.data} section.
6769
7542af2a
AM
6770Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6771particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6772
252b5132
RH
6773@node Builtin Functions
6774@subsection Builtin Functions
6775@cindex functions in expressions
6776The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6777use in linker script expressions.
6778
6779@table @code
6780@item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6781@kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6782@cindex expression, absolute
6783Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6784of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6785value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6786normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6787
6788@item ADDR(@var{section})
6789@kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6790@cindex section address in expression
7542af2a 6791Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
252b5132 6792script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
7542af2a
AM
6793the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6794@code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6795@code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6796the other two will be absolute:
252b5132
RH
6797@smallexample
6798@group
6799SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6800 .output1 :
a1ab1d2a 6801 @{
252b5132
RH
6802 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6803 @dots{}
6804 @}
6805 .output :
6806 @{
6807 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6808 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6809 @}
6810@dots{} @}
6811@end group
6812@end smallexample
6813
876f4090
NS
6814@item ALIGN(@var{align})
6815@itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6816@kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6817@kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
252b5132
RH
6818@cindex round up location counter
6819@cindex align location counter
876f4090
NS
6820@cindex round up expression
6821@cindex align expression
6822Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6823to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6824doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6825arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6826expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
e0a3af22 6827equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
876f4090
NS
6828
6829Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6830next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6831variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6832input sections:
252b5132
RH
6833@smallexample
6834@group
6835SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6836 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6837 *(.data)
6838 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6839 @}
6840@dots{} @}
6841@end group
6842@end smallexample
6843@noindent
6844The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6845a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6846a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
6847of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6848
6849The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6850
362c1d1a
NS
6851@item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6852@kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6853@cindex section alignment
6854Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6855been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6856evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6857the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
6858value in that section.
6859@smallexample
6860@group
6861SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6862 .output @{
6863 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
6864 @dots{}
6865 @}
6866@dots{} @}
6867@end group
6868@end smallexample
6869
252b5132
RH
6870@item BLOCK(@var{exp})
6871@kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
6872This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
6873scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
6874section.
6875
2d20f7bf
JJ
6876@item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6877@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6878This is equivalent to either
6879@smallexample
6880(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
6881@end smallexample
6882or
6883@smallexample
fe6052e1
AM
6884(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
6885 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
2d20f7bf
JJ
6886@end smallexample
6887@noindent
6888depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
6889for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
6890@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
6891If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
6892memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
6893bytes in the on-disk file.
6894
6895This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
6896any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
6897@var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
def5c83c
AM
6898be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
6899running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
6900that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
6901page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
2d20f7bf
JJ
6902
6903@noindent
6904Example:
6905@smallexample
6906 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
6907@end smallexample
6908
6909@item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6910@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6911This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
6912evaluation purposes.
6913
6914@smallexample
6915 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
6916@end smallexample
6917
a4f5ad88
JJ
6918@item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6919@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6920This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
eec2f3ed 6921@samp{-z relro} option is used.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6922When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
6923does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
def5c83c
AM
6924@var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
6925argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
6926script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
eec2f3ed
AM
6927@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
6928padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
6929section alignment.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6930
6931@smallexample
6932 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
6933@end smallexample
6934
252b5132
RH
6935@item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6936@kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6937@cindex symbol defaults
6938Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
420e579c
HPN
6939defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
6940return 0. You can use this function to provide
252b5132
RH
6941default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
6942shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
6943the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
6944existed, its value is preserved:
6945
6946@smallexample
6947@group
6948SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6949 .text : @{
6950 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
6951 @dots{}
6952 @}
6953 @dots{}
6954@}
6955@end group
6956@end smallexample
6957
3ec57632
NC
6958@item LENGTH(@var{memory})
6959@kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
6960Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6961
252b5132
RH
6962@item LOADADDR(@var{section})
6963@kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
6964@cindex section load address in expression
7542af2a 6965Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
252b5132
RH
6966Section LMA}).
6967
2e53f7d6
NC
6968@item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6969@kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6970Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
6971@code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
6972
252b5132
RH
6973@kindex MAX
6974@item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6975Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6976
6977@kindex MIN
6978@item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6979Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6980
6981@item NEXT(@var{exp})
6982@kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
6983@cindex unallocated address, next
6984Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
6985This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
6986use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
6987output file, the two functions are equivalent.
6988
3ec57632
NC
6989@item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6990@kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6991Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6992
ba916c8a
MM
6993@item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6994@kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6995Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
c5da8c7d
NC
6996value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
6997@samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
6998will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
6999can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7542af2a 7000``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
ba916c8a
MM
7001name.
7002
252b5132
RH
7003@item SIZEOF(@var{section})
7004@kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
7005@cindex section size
7006Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
7007been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
7008evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
7009@code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
7010@smallexample
7011@group
7012SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7013 .output @{
7014 .start = . ;
7015 @dots{}
7016 .end = . ;
7017 @}
7018 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
7019 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
7020@dots{} @}
7021@end group
7022@end smallexample
7023
7024@item SIZEOF_HEADERS
7025@itemx sizeof_headers
7026@kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
7027@cindex header size
7028Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
7029information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
7030this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
7031choose, to facilitate paging.
7032
7033@cindex not enough room for program headers
7034@cindex program headers, not enough room
7035When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
7036@code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
7037number of program headers before it has determined all the section
7038addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
7039additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
7040room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
7041the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
7042script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
7043you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
7044command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
7045@end table
7046
7047@node Implicit Linker Scripts
7048@section Implicit Linker Scripts
7049@cindex implicit linker scripts
7050If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
7051an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
7052linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
7053linker will report an error.
7054
7055An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
7056
7057Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
7058assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
7059commands.
7060
7061Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
7062at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
7063read. This can affect archive searching.
7064
bf6d8037
HC
7065@node Plugins
7066@chapter Linker Plugins
7067
7068@cindex plugins
7069@cindex linker plugins
7070The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior.
7071For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers
7072support is implemented with a linker plugin.
7073
7074Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may
7075be added here later.
7076
7077@menu
7078* libdep Plugin:: Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7079@end menu
7080
7081@node libdep Plugin
7082@section Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7083@cindex static library dependencies
7084Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting
7085just of a collection of relocatable object files. Later they evolved to
7086optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects
7087within a library. There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries
7088rose to ascendance.
7089
7090One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting
7091multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their
7092dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic
7093library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly
7094referenced as well. But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a
7095link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static
7096libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to
7097explicitly list the dependencies of the static library.
7098
7099The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option
7100to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep}
7101plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time. The
7102dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l}
7103and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker
7104command line. As such, the information can be written with any text
7105utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not
7106being used to create the archive. The information is stored in an
7107archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}.
7108
7109For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another
7110library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib},
7111the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain
7112
7113@smallexample
7114-L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto
7115@end smallexample
7116
252b5132
RH
7117@ifset GENERIC
7118@node Machine Dependent
7119@chapter Machine Dependent Features
7120
7121@cindex machine dependencies
ff5dcc92
SC
7122@command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
7123sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
252b5132
RH
7124functionality are not listed.
7125
7126@menu
36f63dca
NC
7127@ifset H8300
7128* H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
7129@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
7130@ifset M68HC11
7131* M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7132@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
7133@ifset ARM
7134* ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
7135@end ifset
7136@ifset HPPA
7137* HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
7138@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
7139@ifset M68K
7140* M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7141@end ifset
833794fc
MR
7142@ifset MIPS
7143* MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7144@end ifset
3c3bdf30 7145@ifset MMIX
36f63dca 7146* MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
3c3bdf30 7147@end ifset
2469cfa2 7148@ifset MSP430
36f63dca 7149* MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
2469cfa2 7150@end ifset
35c08157
KLC
7151@ifset NDS32
7152* NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
7153@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
7154@ifset NIOSII
7155* Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7156@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
7157@ifset POWERPC
7158* PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7159@end ifset
7160@ifset POWERPC64
7161* PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7162@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
7163@ifset S/390
7164* S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7165@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
7166@ifset SPU
7167* SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7168@end ifset
74459f0e 7169@ifset TICOFF
ff5dcc92 7170* TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
74459f0e 7171@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
7172@ifset WIN32
7173* WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7174@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
7175@ifset XTENSA
7176* Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7177@end ifset
252b5132
RH
7178@end menu
7179@end ifset
7180
252b5132
RH
7181@ifset H8300
7182@ifclear GENERIC
7183@raisesections
7184@end ifclear
7185
7186@node H8/300
ff5dcc92 7187@section @command{ld} and the H8/300
252b5132
RH
7188
7189@cindex H8/300 support
ff5dcc92 7190For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
252b5132
RH
7191you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7192
7193@table @emph
7194@cindex relaxing on H8/300
7195@item relaxing address modes
ff5dcc92 7196@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
252b5132
RH
7197targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7198program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7199respectively.
7200
7201@cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7202@item synthesizing instructions
81f5558e 7203@c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
ff5dcc92 7204@command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
252b5132
RH
7205sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7206page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7207(That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7208@samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7209top page of memory).
1502569c 7210
81f5558e
NC
7211@command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7212indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7213displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7214the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7215@code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7216whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7217range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7218
1502569c 7219@item bit manipulation instructions
c0065db7 7220@command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
1502569c 7221biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
c0065db7 7222which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
1502569c
NC
7223page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7224(That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
c0065db7 7225@samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c
NC
7226the top page of memory).
7227
7228@item system control instructions
c0065db7
RM
7229@command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
723032 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
1502569c
NC
7231changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7232(That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
c0065db7 7233@samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c 7234the top page of memory).
252b5132
RH
7235@end table
7236
7237@ifclear GENERIC
7238@lowersections
7239@end ifclear
7240@end ifset
7241
36f63dca 7242@ifclear GENERIC
c2dcd04e 7243@ifset Renesas
36f63dca 7244@c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
c2dcd04e
NC
7245@c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7246@node Renesas
7247@chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
36f63dca 7248
c2dcd04e
NC
7249@command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7250H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7251options are required for these chips.
36f63dca
NC
7252@end ifset
7253@end ifclear
7254
36f63dca
NC
7255@ifset ARM
7256@ifclear GENERIC
7257@raisesections
7258@end ifclear
7259
93fd0973
SC
7260@ifset M68HC11
7261@ifclear GENERIC
7262@raisesections
7263@end ifclear
7264
7265@node M68HC11/68HC12
7266@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7267
7268@cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7269
7270@subsection Linker Relaxation
7271
7272For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7273optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7274
7275@table @emph
7276@cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7277@item relaxing address modes
7278@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7279targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7280program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7281respectively.
7282
7283@command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7284transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7285page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7286
7287@item relaxing gcc instruction group
7288When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7289of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7290addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7291@code{bset} instructions.
7292
7293@end table
7294
7295@subsection Trampoline Generation
7296
7297@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7298@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7299For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7300call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
c0065db7 7301will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
93fd0973
SC
7302trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7303case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7304point to the function trampoline.
7305
7306@ifclear GENERIC
7307@lowersections
7308@end ifclear
7309@end ifset
7310
36f63dca 7311@node ARM
3674e28a 7312@section @command{ld} and the ARM family
36f63dca
NC
7313
7314@cindex ARM interworking support
7315@kindex --support-old-code
7316For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
b45619c0 7317between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
36f63dca
NC
7318been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7319line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7320libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
a05a5b64 7321option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
36f63dca
NC
7322given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7323which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7324the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7325non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7326
7327@cindex thumb entry point
7328@cindex entry point, thumb
7329@kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7330The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7331@samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7332But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7333branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7334executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7335
ce11ba6c
KT
7336@cindex PE import table prefixing
7337@kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7338The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7339the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
11e7fd74 7340element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
ce11ba6c
KT
7341import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7342
e489d0ae
PB
7343@cindex BE8
7344@kindex --be8
7345The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
080bb7bb
NC
7346executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7347objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7348option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7349little-endian code.
e489d0ae 7350
3674e28a
PB
7351@cindex TARGET1
7352@kindex --target1-rel
7353@kindex --target1-abs
7354The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7355@samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7356or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7357and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7358
7359@cindex TARGET2
7360@kindex --target2=@var{type}
7361The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7362@samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7363meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7364@table @samp
7365@item rel
eeac373a
PB
7366@samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7367@item abs
a57d1773 7368@samp{R_ARM_ABS32}
3674e28a
PB
7369@item got-rel
7370@samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7371@end table
7372
319850b4
JB
7373@cindex FIX_V4BX
7374@kindex --fix-v4bx
7375The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7376specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7377interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7378also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7379
7380In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7381linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7382@code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7383
7384In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7385relocations are ignored.
7386
845b51d6
PB
7387@cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7388@kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7389Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7390relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7391
7392@smallexample
7393TST rM, #1
7394MOVEQ PC, rM
7395BX Rn
7396@end smallexample
7397
7398This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7399and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
11e7fd74 7400condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
845b51d6 7401
33bfe774
JB
7402@cindex USE_BLX
7403@kindex --use-blx
7404The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7405BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7406situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7407code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7408each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7409
c6dd86c6
JB
7410@cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7411@kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7412The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7413bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7414instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7415to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7416the support code can read the intended values.
7417
7418The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7419intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7420and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7421intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7422full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7423you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7424
7425If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7426enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7427@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7428mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7429vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7430@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7431
7432If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7433potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7434such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7435first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7436instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7437the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7438are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7439
2de70689
MGD
7440@cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7441@kindex --fix-arm1176
7442@kindex --no-fix-arm1176
9d5777a3
RM
7443The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7444in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7445are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
2de70689
MGD
7446unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7447
9d5777a3 7448Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
11e7fd74 7449Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
2de70689
MGD
7450http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7451
a504d23a
LA
7452@cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7453@kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7454
7455The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7456workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7457the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7458off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7459the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7460core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7461integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7462VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7463
7464The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7465necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7466
7467The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7468@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7469STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7470linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7471@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7472
7473If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7474potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7475such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7476replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7477branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7478then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7479
7480The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7481the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7482
7483The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7484they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7485there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7486occurs.
7487
7488The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7489PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7490large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7491cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7492occurs.
7493
bf21ed78
MS
7494@cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7495@kindex --no-enum-size-warning
726150b7 7496The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
bf21ed78
MS
7497warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7498enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7499linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7500using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7501not be diagnosed.
a9dc9481
JM
7502
7503@cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7504@kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7505The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7506warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7507@code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7508linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7509using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
bf21ed78 7510
726150b7
NC
7511@cindex PIC_VENEER
7512@kindex --pic-veneer
7513The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7514ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7515is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7516@samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7517
7518@cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7519@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7520The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7521code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7522perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7523placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
a05a5b64 7524controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
726150b7 7525The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
11e7fd74 7526duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
726150b7
NC
7527group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7528code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7529where they should be placed.
7530
7531The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7532@option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
07d72278 7533placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
726150b7
NC
7534branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7535placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7536value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7537exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7538A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7539linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7540from the input sections.
7541
7542The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7543@samp{N = +1}.
7544
1a51c1a4
NC
7545Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7546only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7547otherwise.
7548
1db37fe6
YG
7549@cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7550@kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7551@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7552The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7553
7554The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7555
68fcca92
JW
7556@cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7557@kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7558@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7559The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7560
7561Please contact ARM for further details.
7562
1db37fe6
YG
7563@kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7564@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7565@cindex Merging exidx entries
7566The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7567
7568@kindex --long-plt
7569@cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7570The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7571which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7572entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7573
1f56df9d
JW
7574@kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7575@cindex AArch64 rela addend
7576The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7577link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7578
4ba2ef8f
TP
7579@cindex Placement of SG veneers
7580All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
a05a5b64 7581Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
4ba2ef8f
TP
7582@samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7583veneers in memory.
7584
54ddd295
TP
7585@kindex --cmse-implib
7586@cindex Secure gateway import library
7587The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7588specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7589secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7590executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7591
0955507f
TP
7592@kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7593@cindex Input import library
7594The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7595must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7596given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7597in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7598@samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7599library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7600library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7601for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7602specified.
7603
36f63dca
NC
7604@ifclear GENERIC
7605@lowersections
7606@end ifclear
7607@end ifset
7608
7609@ifset HPPA
7610@ifclear GENERIC
7611@raisesections
7612@end ifclear
7613
7614@node HPPA ELF32
7615@section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7616@cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7617@kindex --multi-subspace
7618When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7619import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7620The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7621stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7622multiple sub-spaces.
7623
7624@cindex HPPA stub grouping
7625@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7626Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7627stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7628@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7629sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7630a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7631the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7632conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7633prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7634A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7635branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7636@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7637@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7638detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7639positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7640
7641Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7642single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7643create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7644large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7645
7646@ifclear GENERIC
7647@lowersections
7648@end ifclear
7649@end ifset
7650
7fb9f789
NC
7651@ifset M68K
7652@ifclear GENERIC
7653@raisesections
7654@end ifclear
7655
7656@node M68K
7657@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7658
7659@cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7660@kindex --got=@var{type}
7661The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7662The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7663@samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7664the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7665@samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7666entries only at non-negative offsets.
7667@samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7668entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7669support such GOTs.
7670@samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7671output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7672file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7673files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7674
7675@ifclear GENERIC
7676@lowersections
7677@end ifclear
7678@end ifset
7679
833794fc
MR
7680@ifset MIPS
7681@ifclear GENERIC
7682@raisesections
7683@end ifclear
7684
7685@node MIPS
7686@section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7687
7688@cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7689@kindex --insn32
7690@kindex --no-insn32
7691The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7692microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7693in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7694used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7695or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7696including 16-bit ones where possible.
7697
8b10b0b3
MR
7698@cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7699@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7700@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7701The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7702control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7703@samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7704relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7705calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7706relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7707instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7708or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7709the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7710
833794fc
MR
7711@ifclear GENERIC
7712@lowersections
7713@end ifclear
7714@end ifset
7715
36f63dca
NC
7716@ifset MMIX
7717@ifclear GENERIC
7718@raisesections
7719@end ifclear
7720
7721@node MMIX
7722@section @code{ld} and MMIX
7723For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7724@code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7725understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7726can translate between the two formats.
7727
7728There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7729Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7730registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7731equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7732@samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7733global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7734this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7735symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7736
7a2de473
HPN
7737Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7738@code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7739The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7740of a section.
36f63dca
NC
7741
7742Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7743are left out from an mmo file.
7744
7745@ifclear GENERIC
7746@lowersections
7747@end ifclear
7748@end ifset
7749
7750@ifset MSP430
7751@ifclear GENERIC
7752@raisesections
7753@end ifclear
7754
7755@node MSP430
7756@section @code{ld} and MSP430
7757For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7758will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7759just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7760
7761@cindex MSP430 extra sections
7762The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7763
7764@table @code
7765@item @samp{.vectors}
7766Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7767
7768@item @samp{.bootloader}
7769Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7770in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7771
7772@item @samp{.infomem}
7773Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7774this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7775
c0065db7 7776@item @samp{.infomemnobits}
36f63dca
NC
7777This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7778in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7779
7780@item @samp{.noinit}
7781Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7782
c0065db7 7783The last two sections are used by gcc.
36f63dca
NC
7784@end table
7785
7ef3addb
JL
7786@table @option
7787@cindex MSP430 Options
7788@kindex --code-region
7789@item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7790This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7791argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7792using this option.
7793
7794@kindex --data-region
7795@item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7796This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7797[either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7798for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7799
7800@kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7801@item --disable-sec-transformation
7802Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7803and @code{--data-region} options.
7804This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7805wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7806not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7807@end table
7808
36f63dca
NC
7809@ifclear GENERIC
7810@lowersections
7811@end ifclear
7812@end ifset
7813
35c08157
KLC
7814@ifset NDS32
7815@ifclear GENERIC
7816@raisesections
7817@end ifclear
7818
7819@node NDS32
7820@section @code{ld} and NDS32
7821@kindex relaxing on NDS32
7822For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
7823relaxes objects according to these options.
7824
7825@table @code
7826@item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7827Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7828
7829@item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7830Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7831
7832@item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7833Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7834
7835@item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7836Export the EX9 table after linking.
7837
7838@item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7839Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7840
7841@item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7842Update the existing EX9 table.
7843
7844@item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7845Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7846
7847@item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7848Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7849
7850@item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7851Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7852
7853@item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7854Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
7855@end table
7856
7857@ifclear GENERIC
7858@lowersections
7859@end ifclear
7860@end ifset
7861
78058a5e
SL
7862@ifset NIOSII
7863@ifclear GENERIC
7864@raisesections
7865@end ifclear
7866
7867@node Nios II
7868@section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7869@cindex Nios II call relaxation
7870@kindex --relax on Nios II
7871
7872Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
7873transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
7874which may result in @command{ld} giving
7875@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7876The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
7877trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
7878outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
7879trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
7880be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
7881larger than 256MB.
7882
7883The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
7884is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
7885@option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
7886locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
7887source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
7888register as a temporary.
7889
7890Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
7891relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
7892option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
7893
7894@ifclear GENERIC
7895@lowersections
7896@end ifclear
7897@end ifset
7898
2a60a7a8
AM
7899@ifset POWERPC
7900@ifclear GENERIC
7901@raisesections
7902@end ifclear
7903
7904@node PowerPC ELF32
7905@section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7906@cindex PowerPC long branches
7907@kindex --relax on PowerPC
7908Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
7909displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
7910@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7911@samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
7912the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
7913section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
c8a1f254
NS
7914section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
7915@samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
7916both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
7917considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
2a60a7a8
AM
7918
7919@cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
7920@table @option
7921@cindex PowerPC PLT
7922@kindex --bss-plt
7923@item --bss-plt
7924Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
7925generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
7926the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
7927writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
7928@command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
7929PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
7930compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
7931BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
7932
016687f8
AM
7933@kindex --secure-plt
7934@item --secure-plt
7935@command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
7936@samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
7937when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
7938layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
7939style BSS PLT.
7940
2a60a7a8
AM
7941@cindex PowerPC GOT
7942@kindex --sdata-got
7943@item --sdata-got
7944The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
7945sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
7946@code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
7947section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
7948@code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
7949@code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
7950@samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
7951@code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
7952PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
7953pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
7954GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
7955really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
7956
7957@cindex PowerPC stub symbols
7958@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7959@item --emit-stub-syms
7960This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7961symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7962
7963@cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
7964@kindex --no-tls-optimize
7965@item --no-tls-optimize
7966PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7967sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7968disable the optimization.
7969@end table
7970
7971@ifclear GENERIC
7972@lowersections
7973@end ifclear
7974@end ifset
7975
7976@ifset POWERPC64
7977@ifclear GENERIC
7978@raisesections
7979@end ifclear
7980
7981@node PowerPC64 ELF64
7982@section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7983
7984@cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
7985@table @option
7986@cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
7987@kindex --stub-group-size
7988@item --stub-group-size
7989Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
7990by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7991@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7992sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7993a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7994the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7995conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7996prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7997A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7998branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7999@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
8000@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
8001detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
8002positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
8003
8004Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
8005single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
8006create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
8007large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
8008
8009@cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
8010@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8011@item --emit-stub-syms
8012This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8013symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8014
8015@cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
8016@kindex --dotsyms
8017@kindex --no-dotsyms
95421fb9
AM
8018@item --dotsyms
8019@itemx --no-dotsyms
2a60a7a8
AM
8020These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
8021in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
8022function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
8023code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
8024properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
8025to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
8026@samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
8027dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
8028feature.
8029
7ae4ea7d
AM
8030@cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
8031@kindex --save-restore-funcs
8032@kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
95421fb9
AM
8033@item --save-restore-funcs
8034@itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
7ae4ea7d
AM
8035These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
8036provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
8037@samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
8038function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
8039link.
8040
2a60a7a8
AM
8041@cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
8042@kindex --no-tls-optimize
8043@item --no-tls-optimize
8044PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8045sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8046disable the optimization.
8047
7c9cf415
AM
8048@cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
8049@kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
8050@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa
AM
8051@kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
8052@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
95421fb9
AM
8053@item --tls-get-addr-optimize
8054@itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa 8055These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
7c9cf415
AM
8056stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
8057an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
8058@code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
9e7028aa
AM
8059stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
8060generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
8061__tls_get_addr_opt.
8062Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
8063much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
8064an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
8065will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
8066@option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
8067and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
8068this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
8069Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
5cebc931 8070@option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
9e7028aa 8071register saves.
7c9cf415 8072
2a60a7a8
AM
8073@cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
8074@kindex --no-opd-optimize
8075@item --no-opd-optimize
8076PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
8077corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
e7fc76dd 8078the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
2a60a7a8
AM
8079Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
8080
8081@cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
8082@kindex --non-overlapping-opd
8083@item --non-overlapping-opd
8084Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
8085@code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
8086the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
8087entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
8088
8089@cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
8090@kindex --no-toc-optimize
8091@item --no-toc-optimize
8092PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
8093entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
8094reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
8095marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
8096marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
8097relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
8098unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
8099reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
8100discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
8101reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
8102code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
8103optimization.
8104
d882c988
AM
8105@cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
8106@kindex --no-inline-optimize
8107@item --no-inline-optimize
8108PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
8109marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
8110@code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
8111a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
8112locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
8113disables that optimization.
8114
2a60a7a8
AM
8115@cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
8116@kindex --no-multi-toc
8117@item --no-multi-toc
794e51c0
AM
8118If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
8119@code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
8120where TOC
2a60a7a8
AM
8121entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
8122total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
8123grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
8124TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
8125calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
8126help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
812764K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
8128Use this option to turn off this feature.
794e51c0
AM
8129
8130@cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
8131@kindex --no-toc-sort
8132@item --no-toc-sort
8133By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
8134happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
8135placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
8136with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
8137referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
8138@code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
8139results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
8140off this feature.
8141
8142@cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
8143@kindex --plt-align
8144@kindex --no-plt-align
8145@item --plt-align
8146@itemx --no-plt-align
8147Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
2420fff6
AM
8148aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
8149boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
8150specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
8151specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
8152if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
8153PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
794e51c0
AM
8154
8155@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
8156@kindex --plt-static-chain
8157@kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8158@item --plt-static-chain
8159@itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8160Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8161chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8162chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8163
8164@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8165@kindex --plt-thread-safe
8166@kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8167@item --plt-thread-safe
1be5d8d3 8168@itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
794e51c0
AM
8169With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8170lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8171another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8172order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8173memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8174barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8175looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8176seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8177default behaviour.
8b5f1ed8
AM
8178
8179@cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8180@kindex --plt-localentry
8181@kindex --no-plt-localentry
8182@item --plt-localentry
8183@itemx --no-localentry
8184ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8185ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8186(the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8187Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8188or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8189functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8190in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
d44c746a
AM
8191interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8192including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8193to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8194complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8195care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
d882c988
AM
8196
8197@cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8198@kindex --power10-stubs
8199@kindex --no-power10-stubs
8200@item --power10-stubs
8201@itemx --no-power10-stubs
8202When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8203relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
e10a07b3
AM
8204linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8205for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8206power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
d882c988
AM
8207power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8208allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
e10a07b3
AM
8209@option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8210auto mode.
2a60a7a8
AM
8211@end table
8212
8213@ifclear GENERIC
8214@lowersections
8215@end ifclear
8216@end ifset
8217
b4cbbe8f
AK
8218@ifset S/390
8219@ifclear GENERIC
8220@raisesections
8221@end ifclear
8222
8223@node S/390 ELF
8224@section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8225
8226@cindex S/390 ELF options
8227@table @option
8228
8229@cindex S/390
8230@kindex --s390-pgste
8231@item --s390-pgste
8232This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8233segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8234binaries marked that way.
8235@end table
8236
8237@ifclear GENERIC
8238@lowersections
8239@end ifclear
8240@end ifset
8241
49fa1e15
AM
8242@ifset SPU
8243@ifclear GENERIC
8244@raisesections
8245@end ifclear
8246
8247@node SPU ELF
8248@section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8249
8250@cindex SPU ELF options
8251@table @option
8252
8253@cindex SPU plugins
8254@kindex --plugin
8255@item --plugin
8256This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8257
8258@cindex SPU overlays
8259@kindex --no-overlays
8260@item --no-overlays
8261Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8262regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8263@command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8264turns off all this special overlay handling.
8265
8266@cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8267@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8268@item --emit-stub-syms
8269This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8270symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8271
8272@cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8273@kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8274@item --extra-overlay-stubs
8275This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8276function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8277on calls to non-overlay regions.
8278
8279@cindex SPU local store size
8280@kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8281@item --local-store=lo:hi
8282@command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8283the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8284range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8285
c0065db7 8286@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8287@kindex --stack-analysis
8288@item --stack-analysis
8289SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8290unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8291under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8292@command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8293@command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8294determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8295for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8296for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8297for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8298find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8299and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8300under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8301dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8302is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8303and calls will be given.
8304
c0065db7 8305@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8306@kindex --emit-stack-syms
8307@item --emit-stack-syms
8308This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8309in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8310These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8311functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8312functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8313such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8314The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
c0065db7 8315@code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
49fa1e15
AM
8316@end table
8317
8318@ifclear GENERIC
8319@lowersections
8320@end ifclear
8321@end ifset
8322
36f63dca
NC
8323@ifset TICOFF
8324@ifclear GENERIC
8325@raisesections
8326@end ifclear
8327
8328@node TI COFF
8329@section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8330@cindex TI COFF versions
8331@kindex --format=@var{version}
8332The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8333TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8334also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8335format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8336header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8337
8338@ifclear GENERIC
8339@lowersections
8340@end ifclear
8341@end ifset
8342
2ca22b03
NC
8343@ifset WIN32
8344@ifclear GENERIC
8345@raisesections
8346@end ifclear
8347
8348@node WIN32
8349@section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8350
c0065db7 8351This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
a05a5b64
TP
8352See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8353command-line options mentioned here.
2ca22b03
NC
8354
8355@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8356@cindex import libraries
8357@item import libraries
69da35b5 8358The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
2ca22b03 8359libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
69da35b5
NC
8360regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8361archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
2ca22b03 8362support for creating such libraries provided with the
a05a5b64 8363@samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
2ca22b03 8364
c0065db7
RM
8365@item exporting DLL symbols
8366@cindex exporting DLL symbols
dc8465bf
NC
8367The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8368
8369@table @emph
8370@item using auto-export functionality
8371@cindex using auto-export functionality
8372By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
a05a5b64 8373which is controlled by the following command-line options:
dc8465bf 8374
0a5d968e
NC
8375@itemize
8376@item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8377@item --exclude-symbols
8378@item --exclude-libs
e1c37eb5 8379@item --exclude-modules-for-implib
09e2aba4 8380@item --version-script
0a5d968e
NC
8381@end itemize
8382
09e2aba4
DK
8383When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8384(global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8385symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8386often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8387private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
9d5777a3 8388options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
09e2aba4
DK
8389exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8390final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8391
8392If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
0a5d968e
NC
8393command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8394if either of the following are true:
8395
8396@itemize
8397@item A DEF file is used.
8398@item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8399@end itemize
dc8465bf 8400
c0065db7
RM
8401@item using a DEF file
8402@cindex using a DEF file
dc8465bf
NC
8403Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8404an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8405exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8406name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
0a5d968e 8407command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
dc8465bf
NC
8408
8409@example
8410gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8411@end example
8412
0a5d968e
NC
8413Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8414@samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8415
dc8465bf
NC
8416Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8417
8418@example
4b5bd4e7 8419LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
dc8465bf
NC
8420
8421EXPORTS
8422foo
8423bar
8424_bar = bar
4b5bd4e7
DS
8425another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8426var1 DATA
7fcab871
KT
8427doo = foo == foo2
8428eoo DATA == var1
c0065db7 8429@end example
dc8465bf 8430
7fcab871 8431This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
4b5bd4e7
DS
8432symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8433alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8434by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8435@code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
7fcab871
KT
8436@code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8437export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8438in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8439symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
4b5bd4e7 8440
6b31ad16
DS
8441The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8442name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8443the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8444
b45619c0
NC
8445When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8446library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
6b31ad16 8447@code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
c0065db7 8448executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
6b31ad16
DS
8449
8450With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8451specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
c0065db7 8452non-default base address for the image.
6b31ad16
DS
8453
8454If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
a2877985
DS
8455or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8456filename specified on the command line.
6b31ad16 8457
4b5bd4e7
DS
8458The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8459
8460@example
8461EXPORTS
8462 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8463 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
7fcab871 8464 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
c0065db7 8465@end example
4b5bd4e7
DS
8466
8467Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8468@samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8469@samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8470@samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8471Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
7fcab871
KT
8472@samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8473string in import/export table for the symbol.
4b5bd4e7
DS
8474
8475The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8476
8477@code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8478will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8479by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8480linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8481library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8482
8483@code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8484The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8485the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8486@code{*_imp__foo}).
8487
8488@code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8489well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8490read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8491variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8492the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8493extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8494application will behave unexpectedly.
8495
8496@code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8497it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8498symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
de194d85 8499API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
4b5bd4e7 8500the DLL without an import library.
c0065db7 8501
4b5bd4e7
DS
8502See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8503other DEF file statements
dc8465bf
NC
8504
8505@cindex creating a DEF file
8506While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
a05a5b64 8507with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
0a5d968e
NC
8508
8509@item Using decorations
8510@cindex Using decorations
8511Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8512itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8513declared as:
8514
8515@example
8516__declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8517__declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8518@end example
8519
8520All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8521any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8522this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8523the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8524
8525Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
c0065db7 8526decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
0a5d968e
NC
8527instead:
8528
8529@example
8530__declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8531__declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8532@end example
8533
c0065db7
RM
8534This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8535when included by the library itself the header must declare the
0a5d968e
NC
8536variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8537code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
c0065db7 8538of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
0a5d968e
NC
8539omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8540@samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
b45619c0 8541information.
c0065db7 8542@end table
dc8465bf 8543
2ca22b03
NC
8544@cindex automatic data imports
8545@item automatic data imports
8546The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
69da35b5 8547by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
2ca22b03 8548compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
c0065db7 8549issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
69da35b5 8550code to these platforms, especially for large
2ca22b03 8551c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
c0065db7 8552initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
b45619c0 8553decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
c0065db7 8554platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
69da35b5
NC
8555command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8556The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8557suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8558trigger the feature's use.
8559
c0065db7 8560auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
69da35b5
NC
8561additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8562
c0065db7 8563"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
69da35b5
NC
8564documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8565
c0065db7
RM
8566The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8567occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8568One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
69da35b5
NC
8569below.
8570
8571@cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
c0065db7
RM
8572For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8573object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8574offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8575field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8576in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
69da35b5 8577without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
c0065db7 8578The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
69da35b5
NC
8579references.
8580
c0065db7
RM
8581The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8582be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8583themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8584runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8585compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8586support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
69da35b5
NC
8587run without error on an older system.
8588
c0065db7
RM
8589@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8590enabled as needed.
2ca22b03
NC
8591
8592@cindex direct linking to a dll
8593@item direct linking to a dll
8594The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8595including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
69da35b5 8596libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
b45619c0 8597traditional import library method, especially when linking large
c0065db7
RM
8598libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8599function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8600though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
69da35b5 8601storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
c0065db7 8602tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
69da35b5
NC
8603large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8604
c0065db7 8605Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
69da35b5 8606@samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
c0065db7 8607of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
69da35b5
NC
8608perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8609select the dll instead of an import library.
8610
2ca22b03 8611
69da35b5
NC
8612For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8613to find, in the first directory of its search path,
2ca22b03
NC
8614
8615@example
45e948fe
NC
8616libxxx.dll.a
8617xxx.dll.a
8618libxxx.a
8619xxx.lib
f6c4d4b1 8620libxxx.lib
69da35b5 8621cygxxx.dll (*)
45e948fe
NC
8622libxxx.dll
8623xxx.dll
2ca22b03
NC
8624@end example
8625
69da35b5
NC
8626before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8627
c0065db7
RM
8628(*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8629where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8630@samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8631file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
69da35b5
NC
8632@samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8633
c0065db7
RM
8634Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8635@samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
69da35b5
NC
8636was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8637various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8638could coexist on the same machine.
8639
2ca22b03
NC
8640The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8641applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
69da35b5 8642libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
2ca22b03
NC
8643
8644@example
8645bin/
8646 cygxxx.dll
8647lib/
8648 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
c0065db7 8649 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
2ca22b03
NC
8650@end example
8651
c0065db7
RM
8652Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8653done two ways:
2ca22b03
NC
8654
86551. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8656@example
8657gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8658@end example
2ca22b03 8659
69da35b5
NC
8660However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8661(@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8662@samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8663not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8664
2ca22b03
NC
86652. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8666directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8667should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8668making the app/dll.
8669
8670@example
8671ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
c0065db7 8672@end example
2ca22b03
NC
8673
8674Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8675
8676@example
8677gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8678@end example
69da35b5
NC
8679
8680This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8681perfectly legal
8682
8683@example
8684bin/
8685 cygxxx-5.dll
8686lib/
c0065db7 8687 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
69da35b5
NC
8688@end example
8689
dc8465bf 8690Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
69da35b5
NC
8691even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8692@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8693
8694Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
45e948fe 8695wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
69da35b5
NC
8696
86971. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8698work with auto-imported data.
8699
dc8465bf
NC
87002. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8701import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8702symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8703for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8704possible to do this without an import lib.
69da35b5 8705
45e948fe
NC
87063. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8707critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8708in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8709stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8710
69da35b5 8711So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
c0065db7
RM
8712true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8713a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8714binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
69da35b5
NC
8715massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8716requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8717will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
dc8465bf 8718
c0065db7 8719@item symbol aliasing
dc8465bf 8720@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8721@item adding additional names
8722Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
dc8465bf
NC
8723A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8724exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8725when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
c0065db7 8726import library. Consider the following DEF file:
dc8465bf 8727
c0065db7 8728@example
dc8465bf
NC
8729LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8730
8731EXPORTS
c0065db7 8732foo
dc8465bf 8733_foo = foo
c0065db7 8734@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8735
8736The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8737
8738Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8739source code using the "weak" attribute:
8740
c0065db7
RM
8741@example
8742void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
dc8465bf 8743void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
c0065db7 8744@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8745
8746See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8747symbols.
8748
8749@item renaming symbols
8750Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
c0065db7 8751kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
dc8465bf
NC
8752@samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8753DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
c0065db7 8754created). In the following example:
dc8465bf 8755
c0065db7 8756@example
dc8465bf
NC
8757LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8758
8759EXPORTS
8760_foo = foo
c0065db7 8761@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8762
8763The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8764@samp{_foo}.
c0065db7 8765@end table
dc8465bf 8766
0a5d968e 8767Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
a05a5b64 8768unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
0a5d968e 8769If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
c0065db7
RM
8770@emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8771that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8772@samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8773renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8774to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8775the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8776In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
0a5d968e 8777which is probably not what you wanted.
c87db184
CF
8778
8779@cindex weak externals
8780@item weak externals
8781The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8782weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8783defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8784are three variants of weak externals:
8785@itemize
8786@item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8787called lazy externals.
8788@item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8789This form is not presently implemented.
8790@item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8791implemented.
8792@end itemize
8793As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8794are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8795uses a default value.
c1711530
DK
8796
8797@cindex aligned common symbols
8798@item aligned common symbols
8799As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8800desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8801the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8802carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8803by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8804tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8805but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8806warnings about unknown linker directives.
5063daf7 8807
2ca22b03
NC
8808@end table
8809
8810@ifclear GENERIC
8811@lowersections
8812@end ifclear
8813@end ifset
8814
e0001a05
NC
8815@ifset XTENSA
8816@ifclear GENERIC
8817@raisesections
8818@end ifclear
8819
8820@node Xtensa
8821@section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8822
8823@cindex Xtensa processors
8824The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8825@code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8826specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8827keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
8828example, with the command:
8829
8830@smallexample
8831SECTIONS
8832@{
8833 .text : @{
8834 *(.literal .text)
8835 @}
8836@}
8837@end smallexample
8838
8839@noindent
8840@command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8841and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8842literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
8843interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8844group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8845files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8846and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
e0001a05 8847
43cd72b9 8848@cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
e0001a05 8849@cindex relaxing on Xtensa
43cd72b9
BW
8850Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8851provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
8852is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
8853literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8854will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
8855location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
8856the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
8857unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
8858@code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
8859range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
8860
8861For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
8862to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
8863instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
8864instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
8865instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
8866@code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
8867hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
8868By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
8869switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
8870density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
8871instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
8872performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
8873linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
8874a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
8875
8876The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
8877control the linker:
8878
8879@cindex Xtensa options
8880@table @option
43cd72b9
BW
8881@item --size-opt
8882When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
8883more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
8884no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
8885alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
8886preserve the correctness of the code.
7a77f1ac
MF
8887
8888@item --abi-windowed
8889@itemx --abi-call0
8890Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
8891PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
8892because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
8893conventions.
8894Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
8895of the first input object.
8896A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
8897or the chosen output object ABI.
43cd72b9 8898@end table
e0001a05
NC
8899
8900@ifclear GENERIC
8901@lowersections
8902@end ifclear
8903@end ifset
8904
252b5132
RH
8905@ifclear SingleFormat
8906@node BFD
8907@chapter BFD
8908
8909@cindex back end
8910@cindex object file management
8911@cindex object formats available
8912@kindex objdump -i
8913The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
8914These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
8915object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
8916format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
8917it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
8918associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
8919object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
8920(@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
8921list all the formats available for your configuration.
8922
8923@cindex BFD requirements
8924@cindex requirements for BFD
8925As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
8926several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
8927BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
8928formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
8929been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
8930BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
8931may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
8932
8933One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
8934mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
8935useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
8936conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
8937
8938@menu
8939* BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
8940@end menu
8941
8942@node BFD outline
36f63dca 8943@section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
252b5132
RH
8944@cindex opening object files
8945@include bfdsumm.texi
8946@end ifclear
8947
8948@node Reporting Bugs
8949@chapter Reporting Bugs
ff5dcc92
SC
8950@cindex bugs in @command{ld}
8951@cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
252b5132 8952
ff5dcc92 8953Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
252b5132
RH
8954
8955Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
8956it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
ff5dcc92 8957to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
252b5132 8958work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
ff5dcc92 8959@command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
8960
8961In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
8962information that enables us to fix the bug.
8963
8964@menu
8965* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
8966* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
8967@end menu
8968
8969@node Bug Criteria
36f63dca 8970@section Have You Found a Bug?
252b5132
RH
8971@cindex bug criteria
8972
8973If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
8974
8975@itemize @bullet
8976@cindex fatal signal
8977@cindex linker crash
8978@cindex crash of linker
8979@item
8980If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
ff5dcc92 8981@command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
252b5132
RH
8982
8983@cindex error on valid input
8984@item
ff5dcc92 8985If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
252b5132
RH
8986
8987@cindex invalid input
8988@item
ff5dcc92 8989If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
252b5132
RH
8990may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
8991object files are correct.
8992
8993@item
8994If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
ff5dcc92 8995improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
252b5132
RH
8996@end itemize
8997
8998@node Bug Reporting
36f63dca 8999@section How to Report Bugs
252b5132 9000@cindex bug reports
ff5dcc92 9001@cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
252b5132
RH
9002
9003A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
ff5dcc92 9004products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
252b5132
RH
9005recommend you contact that organization first.
9006
9007You can find contact information for many support companies and
9008individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
9009distribution.
9010
ad22bfe8 9011@ifset BUGURL
ff5dcc92 9012Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
ad22bfe8
JM
9013@value{BUGURL}.
9014@end ifset
252b5132
RH
9015
9016The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
9017@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
9018fact or leave it out, state it!
9019
9020Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
9021problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
b553b183
NC
9022assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
9023matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
9024the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
9025location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
9026were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
9027into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
9028specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
c0065db7 9029and the most helpful.
b553b183
NC
9030
9031Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
9032the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
9033on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
252b5132
RH
9034
9035Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
36f63dca
NC
9036bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
9037respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
9038You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
252b5132
RH
9039
9040To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
9041
9042@itemize @bullet
9043@item
ff5dcc92 9044The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
252b5132
RH
9045the @samp{--version} argument.
9046
9047Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
ff5dcc92 9048the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
9049
9050@item
ff5dcc92 9051Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
252b5132
RH
9052patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
9053
9054@item
9055The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
9056version number.
9057
9058@item
ff5dcc92 9059What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
252b5132
RH
9060``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
9061
9062@item
9063The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
9064observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
9065list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
9066sufficient.
9067
9068If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
9069and then we might not encounter the bug.
9070
9071@item
9072A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
b553b183
NC
9073bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
9074provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
9075bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
9076state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
9077requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
9078we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
9079attachments are best.
252b5132
RH
9080
9081If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
9082@code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
9083object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
9084@code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
9085how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
9086
9087@item
9088A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
9089incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
9090
ff5dcc92 9091Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
252b5132
RH
9092will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
9093not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
9094a chance to make a mistake.
9095
9096Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
9097say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
b45619c0 9098copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
252b5132
RH
9099C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
9100and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
9101fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
9102you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
9103any conclusion from our observations.
9104
9105@item
ff5dcc92 9106If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
252b5132
RH
9107diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
9108@samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
ff5dcc92 9109If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
252b5132
RH
9110context, not by line number.
9111
9112The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
9113sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
9114@end itemize
9115
9116Here are some things that are not necessary:
9117
9118@itemize @bullet
9119@item
9120A description of the envelope of the bug.
9121
9122Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
9123which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
9124changes will not affect it.
9125
9126This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
9127will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
9128with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
9129We recommend that you save your time for something else.
9130
9131Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
9132of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
9133output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
9134less time, and so on.
9135
9136However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
9137report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
9138
9139@item
9140A patch for the bug.
9141
9142A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
9143the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
9144a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
9145to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
9146
ff5dcc92 9147Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
252b5132
RH
9148construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
9149through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
9150able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
9151fixed.
9152
9153And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
9154patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
9155help us to understand.
9156
9157@item
9158A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9159
9160Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
9161things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9162@end itemize
9163
9164@node MRI
9165@appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9166@cindex MRI compatibility
ff5dcc92
SC
9167To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9168linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
252b5132
RH
9169alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9170described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9171simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
ff5dcc92 9172@command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
252b5132
RH
9173linker commands; these commands are described here.
9174
9175In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9176file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9177features to make use of them.
9178
9179You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9180@samp{-c} command-line option.
9181
9182Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9183command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9184blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
ff5dcc92 9185MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9186issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9187
9188Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9189
9190You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9191lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9192The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9193
9194@table @code
9195@cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9196@item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9197@itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9198Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
252b5132
RH
9199the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9200@code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9201your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9202script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9203commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9204input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9205@code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9206
9207@cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9208@item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9209Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9210in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9211
9212@var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9213
9214@cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9215@item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9216Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9217@var{expression} should be a power of two.
9218
9219@cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9220@item BASE @var{expression}
9221Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9222absolute addresses) in the output file.
9223
9224@cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9225@item CHIP @var{expression}
9226@itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9227This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9228
9229@cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9230@item END
9231This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9232
9233@cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9234@item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9235Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
dc12032b 9236language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
252b5132
RH
9237
9238@cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9239@item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9240Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
ff5dcc92 9241@command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
252b5132
RH
9242
9243The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9244same line, with no change in its effect.
9245
9246@cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9247@item LOAD @var{filename}
9248@itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9249Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
ff5dcc92 9250same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9251command line.
9252
9253@cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9254@item NAME @var{output-name}
ff5dcc92 9255@var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
252b5132
RH
9256MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9257option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9258
9259@cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9260@item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9261@itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9262Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
252b5132
RH
9263order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9264script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9265sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9266file, in the order specified.
9267
9268@cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9269@item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9270@itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9271@itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9272Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9273@var{name} used in the linker input files.
9274
9275@cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9276@item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9277@itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9278@itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9279You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9280specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9281If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9282@var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9283@end table
9284
793c5807
NC
9285@node GNU Free Documentation License
9286@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
36f63dca 9287@include fdl.texi
704c465c 9288
370b66a1
CD
9289@node LD Index
9290@unnumbered LD Index
252b5132
RH
9291
9292@printindex cp
9293
9294@tex
7ca01ed9 9295% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
252b5132
RH
9296% meantime:
9297\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9298\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9299\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9300\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9301\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9302\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9303\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9304\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9305\page\colophon
7ca01ed9 9306% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
252b5132
RH
9307@end tex
9308
252b5132 9309@bye